aboutsummaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorYuri Chornoivan <yurchor@ukr.net>2020-07-21 09:00:28 +0300
committerYuri Chornoivan <yurchor@ukr.net>2020-07-21 09:00:28 +0300
commit9c5c8cf74c01ac06d6b0448254cdb4947cf40be9 (patch)
tree2940d748f4d511d2d29d965e67e85cd8e35a4188 /docs/docs/stable/mcc-help
parenteb67153c434de792f8008454ad89121d839dabe3 (diff)
downloadtools-9c5c8cf74c01ac06d6b0448254cdb4947cf40be9.tar
tools-9c5c8cf74c01ac06d6b0448254cdb4947cf40be9.tar.gz
tools-9c5c8cf74c01ac06d6b0448254cdb4947cf40be9.tar.bz2
tools-9c5c8cf74c01ac06d6b0448254cdb4947cf40be9.tar.xz
tools-9c5c8cf74c01ac06d6b0448254cdb4947cf40be9.zip
Add Bulgarian translation
Diffstat (limited to 'docs/docs/stable/mcc-help')
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC-cover.xml62
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC.xml46
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MageiaUpdate.xml46
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/XFdrake.xml129
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--dav.xml81
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--fileshare.xml68
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--nfs.xml88
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--removable.xml52
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--smb.xml89
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drak3d.xml80
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakauth.xml29
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakautologin.xml39
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakboot.xml189
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug_report.xml71
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakclock.xml50
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect--del.xml18
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect.xml808
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconsole.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakdisk.xml82
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakedm.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfirewall.xml86
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfont.xml66
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakguard.xml100
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakgw.xml123
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakhosts.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakinvictus.xml19
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetcenter.xml152
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetprofile.xml237
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknfs.xml165
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakproxy.xml37
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakrpm-edit-media.xml211
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksambashare.xml226
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksec.xml54
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksnapshot-config.xml49
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksound.xml35
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakups.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakvpn.xml81
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_apache2.xml111
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_bind.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_dhcp.xml194
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_ntp.xml117
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_proftpd.xml102
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_squid.xml238
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_sshd.xml142
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakxservices.xml17
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/harddrake2.xml87
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/keyboarddrake.xml44
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/localedrake.xml55
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/logdrake.xml111
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lsnetdrake.xml26
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lspcidrake.xml50
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-boot.xml41
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-hardware.xml101
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-intro.xml23
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-localdisks.xml31
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-network.xml82
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networkservices.xml53
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networksharing.xml44
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-security.xml50
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-sharing.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-system.xml76
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mgaapplet-config.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mousedrake.xml26
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/msecgui.xml358
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/otherMageiaTools.xml42
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/rpmdrake.xml251
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/scannerdrake.xml259
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/software-management.xml39
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/system-config-printer.xml341
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/transfugdrake.xml138
-rw-r--r--docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/userdrake.xml154
72 files changed, 7287 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC-cover.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC-cover.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c20c69dd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC-cover.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,62 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<!-- Converted by db4-upgrade version 1.0 -->
+<book xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="MCC">
+
+ <info>
+ <title>Mageia контролен център</title>
+ <cover>
+ <para role="tagline">The tools to configure the Mageia system</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../mageia-2013.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+ <article>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-intro.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="software-management.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-sharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networkservices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-hardware.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-network.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-system.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networksharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-localdisks.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-security.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-boot.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="otherMageiaTools.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</article>
+</book>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c535626f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MCC.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><!-- Converted by db4-upgrade version 1.0 -->
+<article xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="MCC">
+
+ <info>
+ <title>Mageia контролен център</title>
+ <cover>
+ <para xml:id="CC_BY-SA">The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-intro.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="software-management.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-sharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networkservices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-hardware.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-network.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-system.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networksharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-localdisks.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-security.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-boot.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="otherMageiaTools.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</article>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MageiaUpdate.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MageiaUpdate.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d3e1f293
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/MageiaUpdate.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="MageiaUpdate">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="MageiaUpdate-ti1">Обновяване на софтуерни пакети</title>
+
+ <subtitle>MageiaUpdate or drakrpm-update</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="MageiaUpdate-im1" align="center" fileref="MageiaUpdate.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">MageiaUpdate</emphasis> or <emphasis
+role="bold">drakrpm-update</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Software
+management.</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>To work, MageiaUpdate needs the repositories to be configured with
+drakrpm-editmedia with some media checked as updates. If they are not, you
+are prompted to do so.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para>As soon as this tool is launched, it scans the installed packages and lists
+those with an update available in the repositories. They are all selected by
+default to be automatically downloaded and installed. Click on the
+<guibutton>Update</guibutton> button to start the process.</para>
+
+ <para>By clicking on a package, more information is displayed in the lower half of
+the window. The print<emphasis role="bold"> ></emphasis> before a title
+means you can click to drop down a text.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>When updates are available, an applet in the system tray warns you by
+displaying this red icon <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="MageiaUpdate1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject>
+. Just click and enter the user password to update the system alike.</para>
+ </note></para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/XFdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/XFdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..32f0729a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/XFdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,129 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="XFdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="XFdrake-ti1">Настройка на графичен сървър</title>
+
+ <subtitle>XFdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="XFdrake-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="XFdrake.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool is present in the Mageia Control Center under the tab <emphasis
+role="bold">Hardware</emphasis>. Select <emphasis><guilabel>Set up the
+graphical server</guilabel></emphasis>. <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing
+<emphasis>XFdrake</emphasis> as normal user or <emphasis>drakx11</emphasis>
+as root. Mind the capital letters.</para>
+ </footnote></para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>The buttons allow you to change the graphical configuration.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Graphic card</emphasis>:</para>
+
+ <para>The graphic card currently detected is displayed and the matching server
+configured. Click on this button to change to another server, for example
+one with a proprietary driver.</para>
+
+ <para>The available servers are sorted under <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> by
+manufacturer in alphabetical order and then by model also in alphabetical
+order. The free drivers are sorted by alphabetical order under<guilabel>
+Xorg</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>In case of problems, <emphasis>Xorg - Vesa</emphasis> will work with most
+graphic cards and give you time to find and install the right driver while
+in your Desktop Environment.</para>
+
+ <para>If even Vesa doesn't work, choose <emphasis><guilabel>Xorg</guilabel> -
+<guilabel>fbdev</guilabel></emphasis>, which is used while installing
+Mageia, but doesn't allow you to change resolution or refresh rates.</para>
+ </note>If you made your choice for a free driver, you may be asked if you want to
+use a proprietary driver instead with more features (3D effects for
+example).</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Monitor:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>In the same way as above, the monitor currently detected is displayed and
+you can click on the button to change to another one. If the desired monitor
+isn't in the <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> list, choose in the
+<guilabel>Generic</guilabel> list a monitor with the same features.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Resolution:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This button allows the choice of the resolution (number of pixels) and the
+colour depth (number of colours). It displays this screen:</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="XFdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>When you change the color depth, a
+multi-colored bar will appear next to the second button and show a preview
+of what the selected color depth looks like.</para>
+
+ <para>The first button shows the currently resolution, click to change for another
+one. The list gives all the possible choices according to the graphic card
+and the monitor, it is possible to click on <guilabel>Other</guilabel> to
+set other resolutions, but bear in mind that you can damage your monitor or
+select an uncomfortable setting.</para>
+
+ <para>The second button shows the currently colour depth, click to change this for
+another one.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>Depending on the chosen resolution, it may be necessary to logout and
+restart the graphical environment for the settings to take effect.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Test:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Once the configuration done, it is recommended to do a test before clicking
+on OK because it is easier to modify the settings now than later if the
+graphical environment doesn't work.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>In case of a non working graphical environment, type Alt+Ctrl+F2 to open a
+text environment, connect as root and type XFdrake (with the caps) to to use
+XFdrake's text version.</para>
+ </note>If the test fails, just wait until the end, if it works but you don't want
+to change after all, click on <guibutton>No</guibutton>, if everything is
+right, click on <guibutton role="bold">OK</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Options:</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Global options</guilabel>: If <emphasis>Disable
+Ctrl-Alt-Backspace</emphasis> is checked, it will no longer be possible to
+restart X server using Ctrl+Alt+Backspace keys.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Graphic card options</guilabel>: Allows you to enable or disable
+three specific features depending on the graphic card.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Graphical interface at startup</guilabel>: Most of the time,
+<emphasis>Automatically start the graphical interface (Xorg) upon
+booting</emphasis> is checked to make the boot switch to graphical mode, it
+may be unchecked for a server.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>After a click on the <guibutton>Quit</guibutton> button, the system will ask
+you to confirm. There is still time to cancel everything and keep the
+previous configuration, or to accept. In this case, you have to disconnect
+and reconnect to activate the new configuration.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--dav.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--dav.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5d04b388
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--dav.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="diskdrake--dav"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--dav-ti1">Достъп до споделени устройства и директории на WebDAV</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --dav</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="diskdrake--dav1.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake--dav-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --dav</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found in the Mageia
+Control Center, under the Network Sharing tab, labeled <guilabel>Configure
+WebDAV shares</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para><link xlink:href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/WebDAV">WebDAV</link> is a
+protocol that allows to mount a web server's directory locally, so that it
+appears as a local directory. It is necessary that the remote machine run a
+WebDAV server. This is not the aim of this tool to configure the WebDAV
+server.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Creating a new entry</title>
+
+ <para>The first screen of the tool displays the already configured entries, if
+any, and a <guibutton>New</guibutton> button. Use it to create a new
+entry. Insert the server URL in the field of the new screen.</para>
+
+ <para>Then you get a screen with radio buttons to select some actions. Continue
+with the action <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> by clicking
+<guibutton>OK</guibutton> after selecting the radio button, as the
+<guibutton>Server</guibutton> is already configured. You can however correct
+it, if needed.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--dav3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The content of the remote directory will be accessible through this mount
+point.</para>
+
+ <para>In the next step, give your user name and password. If you need some other
+options, you can give them in the <guibutton>advanced</guibutton> screen.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--dav4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The option <guibutton>Mount</guibutton> allows you to mount immediately the
+access.</para>
+
+ <para>After you accepted the configuration with the radio button
+<guibutton>Done</guibutton>, the first screen is displayed again and your
+new mount point is listed. After you choose <guibutton>Quit</guibutton>, you
+are asked whether or not to save the modifications in
+<emphasis>/etc/fstab</emphasis>. Choose this option if you want that the
+remote directory is available at each boot. If your configuration is for
+one-time usage, do not save it.</para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--fileshare.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--fileshare.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5d07143b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--fileshare.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="diskdrake--fileshare"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!--2079.07.07 apb: Corrected syntax for userdrake link. -->
+<title xml:id="diskdrake--fileshare-ti1">Споделяне на дяловете на твърдия диск</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --fileshare</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="diskdrake--fileshare.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake--fileshare-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This simple tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --fileshare</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you, the
+administrator, to allow users to share parts of their own /home
+subdirectories with other users of a same local network which may have
+computers running either Linux or Windows operating system.</para>
+
+ <para>It is found in the Mageia Control Center, under the Local Disk tab, labelled
+"Share your hard disk partitions".</para>
+
+ <para>First, answer the question : "<guilabel>Would you like to allow users to
+share some of their directories ?</guilabel>", click on <guibutton>No
+sharing</guibutton> if the answer is no for all users, click on
+<guibutton>Allow all users</guibutton> for all users and click on
+<guibutton>Custom</guibutton> if the answer is no for some users and yes for
+the others. In this last case, the users that are authorised to share their
+directories must belong to the fileshare group, which is automatically
+created by the system. You will be asked about this later.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on <guilabel>OK</guilabel>, a second screen appears which asks you
+choose between <guibutton>NFS</guibutton> or <guibutton>SMB</guibutton>.
+Check <guibutton>NFS</guibutton> if Linux is the only operating system on
+the network, check <guibutton>SMB</guibutton> if the network includes both
+Linux and Windows machines and then click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. Any
+required packages will be installed if necessary.</para>
+
+ <para>The configuration is now complete unless the Custom option was chosen. In
+this case, an extra screen prompts you to open Userdrake. This tool allows
+you to add users authorised to share their directories to the fileshare
+group. In the User tab, click on the user to add to the fileshare group,
+then on <guimenuitem>Edit</guimenuitem>, In the Groups tab. Check the
+fileshare group and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. For more information
+about Userdrake, see: <xref linkend="userdrake"/></para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>When adding a new user to the fileshare group, you have to disconnect and
+reconnect the network for the modifications to be taken into account.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>From now on each user belonging to the fileshare group can select in his/her
+file manager the directories to be shared, although not all file managers
+have this facility.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--nfs.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--nfs.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6a0b720f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--nfs.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="diskdrake--nfs">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--nfs-ti1">Достъп до споделени устройства и директории на NFS</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --nfs</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="2" xml:id="diskdrake--nfs-im1" align="center" fileref="diskdrake--nfs.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --nfs</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to declare some
+shared directories to be accessible to all users on the machine. The
+protocol used for this is NFS which is available on most Linux or Unix
+systems. The shared directory will be thus available directly at
+boot. Shared directories can be also accessible directly in a single session
+for a user with tools such as file browsers.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Procedure</title>
+
+ <para>Select <guibutton>search servers</guibutton> to obtain a list of servers
+which share directories.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on the > symbol before the server name to display the list of the
+shared directories and select the directory you want to access.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject ns2:href="diskdrake--nfs2.png">
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The button <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> will be available and you have
+to specify where to mount the directory.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject ns2:href="diskdrake--nfs3.png">
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>After choosing the mount point, You can mount it. You can also verify and
+change some options with the <guibutton>Options</guibutton> button. After
+mounting the directory, you can unmount it with the same button.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>On accepting the configuration with the <guibutton>Done</guibutton> button,
+a message will displayed, asking "Do you want to save the /etc/fstab
+modifications". This will make the directory available at each boot, if the
+network is accessible. The new directory is then available in your file
+browser, for example in Dolphin.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--removable.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--removable.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..90b230a0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--removable.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="diskdrake--removable">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--removable-ti1">CD/DVD burner</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --removable</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="diskdrake--removable.png" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="diskdrake--removable-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --removable</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote>is found under the tab Local
+disks in the Mageia Control Center labelled accordingly with your removable
+hardware (CD/DVD players and burners and floppy drives only). </para>
+
+ <para>Its goal is to define the way your removable disk is mounted. </para>
+
+ <para>At the top of the window there is a short description of your hardware and
+the chosen options to mount it. Use the menu on the bottom to change
+them. Check the item to be changed and then on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton>
+button. </para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Точка на монтиране</title>
+
+ <para>Check this box to change the mount point. The default one is /media/cdrom.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Опции</title>
+
+ <para>Many mount options can be chosen here either directly in the list or via the
+<guilabel>Advanced</guilabel> submenu. The main are:</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>user/nouser</title>
+
+ <para>user allows an ordinary user (not root) to mount the removable disk, this
+option involves noexec, nosuid and nodev. The user who mounted the disk is
+the only one who can umount it. </para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--smb.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--smb.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8eae5d66
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/diskdrake--smb.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,89 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="diskdrake--smb"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--smb-ti1">Достъп до споделени устройства и директории на Windows (SMB)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --smb</subtitle>
+
+ </info>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --smb</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to declare which
+shared directories to be accessible to all users on the machine. The
+protocol used for this is SMB which has been popularized on Windows(R)
+systems. The shared directory will be available directly at boot. Shared
+directories can be also accessed directly in a single session by a user with
+tools such as file browsers.</para>
+
+ <para>Before starting the tool, it is a good idea to declare the names of
+available servers, for example with <xref linkend="drakhosts"/></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Procedure</title>
+
+ <para>Select <guibutton>search servers</guibutton> to obtain a list of servers who
+share directories.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on the server name and on &gt; before the server name to display the
+list of the shared directories and select the directory you want to access.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> button will become available, you
+have to specify where to mount the directory.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>After choosing the mount point, it can be mounted with the <guimenu>Mount
+button</guimenu>. You can also verify and change some options with the
+<guibutton>Options</guibutton> button.</para>
+
+ <para>In options, you can specify the user name and the password of those able to
+connect to the SMB server. After mounting the directory, you can unmount it
+with the same button.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>After accepting the configuration with the Done button, a message will ask
+"Do you want to save the /etc/fstab modifications". Saving, will allow
+directory to made available at each boot, if the network is accessible. The
+new directory is then available in your file browser, for example in
+dolphin.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drak3d.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drak3d.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..44e57e04
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drak3d.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drak3d" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drak3d-ti1">3D Desktop Effects</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drak3d</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drak3d-im1" revision="1" align="center" fileref="drak3d.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drak3d</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> lets you manage the 3D
+desktop effects on your operating system. 3D effects are turned off by
+default.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section annotations="center">
+ <title>Getting Started</title>
+
+ <para>To use this tool, you need to have the glxinfo package installed. If the
+package is not installed, you will be prompted to do so before drak3d can
+start.</para>
+
+ <para>After starting drak3d, you will be presented with a menu window. Here you
+can choose either <guilabel>No 3D Desktop Effects</guilabel> or
+<guilabel>Compiz Fusion</guilabel>. Compiz Fusion is part of a
+composite/window manager, which includes hardware-accelerated special
+effects for your desktop. Choose <guilabel>Compiz Fusion</guilabel> to turn
+it on.</para>
+
+ <para>If this is your first time using this program after a clean installation of
+Mageia, you will get a warning message telling you which packages need to be
+installed in order to use Compiz Fusion. Click on the
+<guibutton>Ok</guibutton> button to continue.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drak3d-im3" fileref="drak3d_installing_CompizFusion.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Once the appropriate packages are installed, you will notice that Compiz
+Fusion is selected in the drak3d menu, but you must log out and log back in
+for the changes to take effect.</para>
+
+ <para>After logging back in, Compiz Fusion will be activated. To configure Compiz
+Fusion, see the page for the ccsm (CompizConfig Settings Manager) tool.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Troubleshooting</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Can't See Desktop after Logging in</title>
+
+ <para>If after turning on Compiz Fusion you attempt to log back into your desktop
+but can't see anything, restart your computer to get back to the log in
+screen. Once there, click on the Desktop icon and select drak3d.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drak3d_troubleshooting_login_option.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>When you log in, if your account is listed as an administrator, you will be
+prompted for your password again. Otherwise, use the administrator login
+with his/her account. Then you can undo any changes that may have caused the
+log in problem.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakauth.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakauth.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..280f63b3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakauth.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakauth" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakauth-ti1">Идентификация</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakauth</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakauth.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakauth-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakauth</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> enables you to modify the
+manner in which you can be recognized as user of the machine or on the net.</para>
+
+ <para>By default, information for your authentication is stored in a file on your
+computer. Modify it only if your network administrator invites you to do so
+and give information about that.</para>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakautologin.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakautologin.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4bf552b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakautologin.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakautologin">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakautologin-ti1">Настройка за автоматично влизане</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakautologin</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakautologin-im1" fileref="drakautologin.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakautologin</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to automatically
+login the same user, in her/his desktop environment, without asking for any
+password. It's called autologin. This is generally a good idea when there
+is only one user like to be using the machine.</para>
+
+ <para>It is found under the <emphasis role="bold">Boot</emphasis> tab in the
+Mageia Control Center labelled "Set up autologin to automatically log in".</para>
+
+ <para>The interface buttons are pretty obvious:</para>
+
+ <para>Check <guibutton>Launch the graphical environment when your system
+starts</guibutton>, if you want X Window System to be executed after the
+boot. If not, the system will start in text mode. Nevertheless, it will be
+possible to launch the graphic interface manually. This can be done by
+launching the command 'startx' or 'systemctl start dm'.</para>
+
+ <para>If the first box is checked, two other options are available, check either
+<guibutton>No, I don't want autologin</guibutton>, if you want the system to
+continue to ask for which user to connect (and password) or check
+<guibutton>Yes, I want autologin with this (user, desktop)</guibutton>, if
+needed. In this case, you also need to supply the <guilabel>Default
+username</guilabel> and the <guilabel>Default desktop</guilabel>.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakboot.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakboot.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2ca4b288
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakboot.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,189 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakboot" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakboot-ti1">Настройка на системата за начално зареждане</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakboot</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="drakboot--boot-im1" align="center" fileref="drakboot--boot.png" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If you are using a UEFI system instead of BIOS, the user interface is
+slightly different as the boot device is obviously the EFI system Partition
+(ESP).</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot--boot2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakboot</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to configure the
+boot options (choice of the bootloader, set a password, the default boot,
+etc.)</para>
+
+ <para>It is found under the Boot tab in the Mageia Control Center labeled "Set up
+boot system".</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Don't use this tool if you don't know exactly what you are doing. Changing
+some settings may prevent your machine from booting again !</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>In the first part, called <guilabel>Bootloader</guilabel>, it is possible if
+using BIOS, to choose which <guibutton>Bootloader to use</guibutton>, Grub,
+Grub2 or Lilo, and with a graphical or a text menu. It is just a question
+of taste, there are no other consequences. You can also set the
+<guibutton>Boot device</guibutton>, don't change anything here unless you
+are an expert. The boot device is where the bootloader is installed and any
+modification can prevent your machine from booting.</para>
+
+ <para>In a UEFI system, the bootloader is <guilabel>Grub2-efi</guilabel> and is
+installed in /boot/EFI partition. This FAT32 formatted partition is common
+to all operating systems installed.</para>
+
+ <para>In the second part, called <guilabel>Main options</guilabel>, you can set
+the <guibutton>Delay before booting default image</guibutton>, in
+seconds. During this delay, Grub or Lilo will display the list of available
+operating systems, prompting you to make your choice. If no selection is
+made, the bootloader will boot the default one once the delay elapses.</para>
+
+ <para>In the third and last part, called <guibutton>Security</guibutton>, it is
+possible to set a password for the bootloader. This means a username and
+password will be asked at the boot time to select a booting entry or change
+settings. The username is "root" and the password is the one chosen here.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button gives some extra options.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable ACPI:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>ACPI (Advanced Configuration and Power Interface) is a standard for the
+power management. It can save energy by stopping unused devices, this was
+the method used before APM. Check this box if your hardware is ACPI
+compatible.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable SMP:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>SMP stands for Symmetric Multi Processors, it's an architecture for
+multicore processors.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you have a processor with HyperThreading, Mageia will see it as a dual
+processor and enable SMP.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable APIC</guibutton> and <guibutton>Enable Local
+APIC:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>APIC stands for Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller. There are two
+components in the Intel APIC system, the local APIC (LAPIC) and the I/O
+APIC. The latter one routes the interrupts it receives from peripheral buses
+to one or more local APICs that are in the processor. It is really useful
+for multi-processor systems. Some computers have problems with the APIC
+system which can cause freezes or incorrect device detection (error message
+"spurious 8259A interrupt: IRQ7"). In this case, disable APIC and/or Local
+APIC.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Next</guibutton> screen differs depending on which boot
+loader you chose.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You have Grub Legacy or Lilo:</para>
+
+ <para>In this case, you can see the list of all the available entries at boot
+time. The default one is asterisked. To change the order of the menu
+entries, click on the up or down arrows to move the selected item. If you
+click on the <guibutton>Add</guibutton> or <guibutton>Modify</guibutton>
+buttons, a new window appears to add a new entry in the bootloader menu or
+to modify an existing one. You need to be familiar with Lilo or Grub to be
+able to use these tools.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Label</guilabel> field is freeform, write here what you want
+to be displayed in the menu. It matches the Grub command "title". For
+example: Mageia3.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Image</guilabel> field contains the kernel name. It matches
+the Grub command "kernel". For example /boot/vmlinuz.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Root</guilabel> field contains the device name where the
+kernel is stored. It matches the Grub command "root". For example (hd0,1).</para>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Append</guilabel> field contains the options to be given to
+the kernel at boot time.</para>
+
+ <para>If the box <guilabel>Default</guilabel> is checked, Grub will boot this
+entry by default.</para>
+
+ <para>In the extra screen called <guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>, it is possible to
+choose the <guilabel>Video mode</guilabel>, an <guilabel>initrd</guilabel>
+file and a <guilabel>network profile</guilabel>, see <xref
+linkend="draknetprofile"/>, in the drop-down lists.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You have Grub2 or Grub2-efi (boot loaders used by default respectively in
+Legacy mode and UEFI mode):</para>
+
+ <para>In this case, the drop-down list labelled <guilabel>Default</guilabel>
+displays all the available entries; click on the one wanted as the default
+one.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Append</guilabel> field contains the options to be given to
+the kernel at boot time.</para>
+
+ <para>If you have other operating systems installed, Mageia attempts to add them
+to your Mageia boot menu. If you don't want this behaviour, uncheck the box
+<guilabel>Probe Foreign OS</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para>In the extra screen called <guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>, it is possible to
+choose the <guilabel>Video mode</guilabel>. If you don't want a bootable
+Mageia, but to chain load it from another OS, check the box <guilabel>Do not
+touch ESP or MBR</guilabel> and accept the warning.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Not installing on ESP or MBR means that the installation is not bootable
+unless chain loaded from another OS.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>To set many other parameters, you can use the tool named <emphasis>Grub
+Customizer</emphasis>, available in the Mageia repositories (see below).</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d2cf85aa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section
+xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakbug" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakbug-ti1">Mageia Bug Report Tool</title><subtitle>drakbug</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakbug-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"
+ fileref="drakbug.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Usually, this tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakbug</emphasis>.</para></footnote> starts automatically
+when a Mageia tool crashes. However, it is also possible that, after filing
+a bug report, you are asked to start this tool to check some of the
+information it gives, and then provide that in that existing bug report.</para>
+
+ <para>If a new bug report needs to be filed and you are not used to doing that,
+then please read <link
+xlink:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/How_to_report_a_bug_properly">How to
+report a bug report properly</link> before clicking on the "Report" button.</para>
+
+ <para>In case the bug has already been filed by someone else (the error message
+that drakbug gave will be the same, then), it is useful to add a comment to
+that existing report that you saw the bug, too.</para>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug_report.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug_report.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3cc447f1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakbug_report.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section
+xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xml:id="drakbug_report" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakbug_report-ti1">Collect Logs and System Information for Bug Reports</title><subtitle>drakbug_report</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakbug_report</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can only be started and used
+on the command line.</para>
+
+<para>It is advised to write the output of this command to a file, for instance by
+doing <emphasis role="bold">drakbug_report > drakbugreport.txt</emphasis>,
+but make sure you have enough disk space first: the file can easily be
+several GBs large.</para>
+<note><para>The output is far too large to attach to a bug report without first removing
+the unneeded parts.</para></note>
+ <para>This command collects the following information on your system:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para> lspci</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> pci_devices</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> dmidecode</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> fdisk</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> scsi</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> /sys/bus/scsi/devices</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> lsmod</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> cmdline</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> pcmcia: stab</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> usb</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> partitions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> cpuinfo</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> syslog</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> Xorg.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> monitor_full_edid</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> stage1.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> ddebug.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> install.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> fstab</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> modprobe.conf</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> lilo.conf</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> grub: menu.lst</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> grub: install.sh</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> grub: device.map</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> xorg.conf</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> urpmi.cfg</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> modprobe.preload</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> sysconfig/i18n</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> /proc/iomem</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> /proc/ioport</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> mageia version</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> rpm -qa</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> df</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+
+ <note><para>At the time this help page was written, the "syslog" part of this command's
+output was empty, because this tool had not yet been adjusted to our switch
+to systemd. If it is still empty, you can retrieve the "syslog" by doing (as
+root) <emphasis role="bold"> journalctl -a > journalctl.txt</emphasis>. If
+you don't have a lot of diskspace, you can, for instance, take the last 5000
+lines of the log instead with: <emphasis role="bold">journalctl -a | tail
+-n5000 > journalctl5000.txt</emphasis>.</para></note>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakclock.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakclock.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..12f96101
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakclock.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakclock">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakclock-ti1">Управление на дата и час</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakclock</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakclock.png" xml:id="drakclock-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakclock</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the tab System
+in the Mageia Control Center labelled <guilabel>"Manage date and
+time"</guilabel>. In some desktop environments it is also available by a
+right click / Adjust date and Time ... on the clock in the system tray.</para>
+
+ <para>It's a very simple tool.</para>
+
+ <para>On the upper left part, is the <emphasis role="bold">calendar</emphasis>. On
+the screenshot above, the date is September (on the upper left), 2012 (on
+the upper right), the 2nd (in blue) and it is a Sunday. Select the month
+(or year) by clicking on the little arrows on each side of September (or
+2012). Select the day by clicking on its number.</para>
+
+ <para>On the bottom left is the <emphasis role="bold">Network Time
+Protocol</emphasis> synchronising, it is possible to have a clock always on
+time by synchronising it with a server. Check <guilabel>Enable Network Time
+Protocol</guilabel> and choose the closest server.</para>
+
+ <para>On the right part is the <emphasis role="bold">clock</emphasis>. It's
+useless to set the clock if NTP is enabled. Three boxes display hours,
+minutes and seconds (15, 28 and 22 on the screenshot). Use the little arrows
+to set the clock to the correct time. The format can't be changed here, see
+your desktop environment settings for that.</para>
+
+ <para>At least, on the bottom right, select your time zone by clicking on the
+<guibutton>Change Time Zone</guibutton> button and choosing in the list the
+nearest town.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Even if it isn't possible to choose a date or time format in this tool, they
+will be displayed on your desktop in accordance with the localisation
+settings.</para>
+ </note>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect--del.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect--del.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c71d2a0e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect--del.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,18 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakconnect--del" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakconnect--del-ti1">Премахване на връзка</title><subtitle>drakconnect --del</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakconnect--del-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakconnect--del.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here, you can delete a network interface<footnote><para>You can also start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakconnect --del</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote>.</para>
+ <para>Click on the drop down menu, choose the one you want to remove and then
+click <emphasis>next</emphasis>.</para>
+ <para>You'll see a message that the network interface has been deleted
+successfully.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..9d417a65
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconnect.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,808 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakconnect">
+ <info annotations="simonnzg listened to Aicha by Khaled &amp; Faudel whilst editing this document.">
+ <title xml:id="drakconnect-ti1">Настройване на нов мрежов интерфейс (LAN, ISDN, ADSL, ...)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakconnect</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakconnect-im1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakconnect.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakconnect</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows to configure much of
+local network or Internet access. You have to know some information from
+your access provider or your network administrator.</para>
+
+ <para>Select the type of connection you want to set, according to which hardware
+and provider you have.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Wired connection (Ethernet)</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The first window lists the interfaces which are available. Select the one
+to configure.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this point, the choice is given between an automatic or a manual IP
+address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Automatic IP</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Ethernet/IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers
+are declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained
+below. In the last case, the IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified,
+the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.
+The Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option
+<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>. Not all DHCP servers
+have such a function and if you're setting up your PC to get an IP address
+from a domestic ADSL router, it is unlikely.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the DHCP client</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>DHCP timeout</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS server</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server
+requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP
+address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After accepting, the last steps which are common to all connection
+configurations are explained: <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Ръчна настройка</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Ethernet/IP settings</emphasis>: you need to declare what DNS
+servers to use. The HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no
+HOSTNAME is specified, the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is
+attributed by default.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the IP address usually looks like
+<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is
+<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are
+available from your service provider's website.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search
+domain</emphasis>. It would usually be your home domain, i.e. if your
+computer is called "splash", and it's full domain name is
+"splash.boatanchor.net", the Search Domain would be "boatanchor.net". Unless
+you specifically need it, it's ok not to define this setting. Again,
+domestic ADSL would not need this setting.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect30.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Satellite connection (DVB)</title>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Cable modem connection</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The first window lists the interfaces which are available. Select the one
+to configure.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this point, the choice is given between an automatic or a manual IP
+address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You have to specify a authentication method:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Няма</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>BPALogin (necessary for Telstra). In this case you have to provide User name
+and password.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Automatic IP</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Cable/IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers
+are declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained
+below. In the last case, the IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified,
+the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.
+The Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option
+<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>. Not all DHCP servers
+have such a function and if you're setting up your PC to get an IP address
+from a domestic ADSL router, it is unlikely.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the DHCP client</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>DHCP timeout</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS server</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server
+requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP
+address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After accepting, the last steps which are common to all connection
+configurations are explained: <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Ръчна настройка</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Cable/IP settings</emphasis>: you need to declare what DNS servers
+to use. The HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME
+is specified, the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is
+attributed by default.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the IP address usually looks like
+<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is
+<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are
+available from your service provider's website.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search
+domain</emphasis>. It would usually be your home domain, i.e. if your
+computer is called "splash", and it's full domain name is
+"splash.boatanchor.net", the Search Domain would be "boatanchor.net". Unless
+you specifically need it, it's ok not to define this setting. Again,
+domestic connection would not need this setting.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect32.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new DSL connection</title>
+
+ <para><orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the tool detects network interfaces, it offers to select one and to
+configure it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select one of the protocols available:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Manual TCP/IP configuration</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PPP over ADSL (PPPoA)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PPP over Ethernet (PPPoE)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Point to Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Настройки за достъп</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Име на акаунта (потебителско име)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Account password</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>(Advanced) Virtual Path ID (VPI)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>(Advanced) Virtual Circuit ID (VCI)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new ISDN connection</title>
+
+ <para><orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard asks which device to configure:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Manual choice (internal ISDN card)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Външен ISDN модем</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of hardware is proposed, classified by category and
+manufacturer. Select your card.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select one of the protocols available:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Protocol for the rest of the world, except Europe (DHCP)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Protocol for Europe (EDSS1)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is then offered, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave
+you. Then it is asked for parameters:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Име на връзката</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Телефонен номер</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Потребителско ИД</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Account password</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Метод за идентификация</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After that, you have to select if you get the IP address by automatic or
+manual method. In the last case, specify IP address and Subnet mask.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next step is to choose how DNS servers address are obtained, by
+automatic or manual method. In the case of manual configuration, you have to
+put:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Име на домейна</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>First and second DNS Server</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select if the hostname is set from IP. This option is to select only if you
+are sure that your provider is configured to accept it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next step is to choose how the gateway address is obtained, by automatic
+or manual method. In the case of manual configuration, you have to enter the
+IP address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Wireless connection (WiFi)</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A first window lists the interfaces which are available and an entry for
+Windows driver (ndiswrapper). Select the one to configure. Use ndiswrapper
+only if the other configuration methods did not work.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this step, the choice is given between the different access points that
+the card has detected.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specific parameter for the wireless card are to provide:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect31.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Operating mode:</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Управляван</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>To access to an existing access point (the most frequent).</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Ad-Hoc</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>To configure direct connection between computers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Network Name (ESSID)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Encryption mode: it depends of how the access point is configured.</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>WPA/WPA2</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This encryption mode is to prefer if your hardware allows it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>WEP</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Some old hardware deals only this encryption method.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Ключ за криптиране</para>
+
+ <para>It is generally provided with the hardware which give the access point.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this step, the choice is given between an automatic IP address or a
+manual IP address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Automatic IP</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers are
+declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained
+below. In the last case, IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is
+specified, the name localhost.localdomain is attributed by default. The
+Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option
+<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the DHCP client</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>DHCP timeout</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS servers</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server
+requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP
+address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After accepting the configuration the step, which is common to all
+connection configurations, is explained: <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Ръчна настройка</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>IP settings</emphasis>: you have to declare DNS servers. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified,
+the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the IP address always looks like
+<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is
+<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are
+available from your providers website.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search
+domain</emphasis>. It must seem to your hostname without the first name,
+before the period.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new GPRS/Edge/3G connection</title>
+
+ <para><orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the tool detects wireless interfaces, it offers to select one and to
+configure it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The PIN is asked. Leave empty if the PIN is not required.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard asks for network. If it is not detected, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Provide access settings</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Access Point Name</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Име на акаунта (потебителско име)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Account password</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Bluetooth Dial-Up Networking connection</title>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Analog telephone modem connection (POTS)</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard asks which device to configure:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Ръчнен избор</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Detected hardware, if any.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of ports is proposed. Select your port.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If not yet installed, it will be suggested that you install the package
+<emphasis>kppp-provider</emphasis>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider
+gave. Then it is asked for Dialup options:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Connection name</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Phone number</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Login ID</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Password</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Authentication</emphasis>, choose between:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PAP/CHAP</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Базиран на скрипт</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PAP</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Базиран на терминал</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>CHAP</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakconnect-end">
+ <title>Ending the configuration</title>
+
+ <para>In the next step, you can specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Allow users to manage the connection</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Start the connection at boot</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Enable traffic accounting</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Allow interface to be controlled by Network Manager</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>In the case of a wireless connection, a supplemental box is <emphasis>Allow
+access point roaming</emphasis> which give the possibility to switch
+automatically between access point according to the signal strength.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>With the advanced button, you can specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Metric (10 by default)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>MTU</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Автоматично включване на мрежата</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Позволи IPv6 към IPv4 тунел</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The last step allows you to specify if the connection is to start
+immediately or not.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect9.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconsole.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconsole.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..aaf45035
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakconsole.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakconsole">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakconsole-ti1">Отваряне на конзола като администратор</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakconsole</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakconsole-im1" fileref="drakconsole.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakconsole</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> gives you access to a console
+which is directly opened as root. We do not think that you need more
+information about that.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakdisk.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakdisk.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4f7e0d0c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakdisk.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakdisk">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakdisk-ti1">Управление на дяловете на диска</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakdisk or diskdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakdiskBackup-im1" revision="1" fileref="drakdiskBackup.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakdisk</emphasis> or <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is very powerful, a tiny
+error or a cat jumping on your keyboard can lead to losing all data on a
+partition or even to erasing the entire hard disk. For that reason, you'll
+see the screen above on top of the tool screen. Click on
+<emphasis>Exit</emphasis> if you're not sure you want to continue.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>If you have more than one hard disk, you can switch to the hard disk you
+want to work on by selecting the correct tab (sda, sdb, sdc etc).</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="drakdisk-im1" fileref="drakdisk.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You can choose from many actions to adjust your hard disk to your
+preferences. Wiping an entire hard disk, splitting or merging partitions,
+resizing them or changing the filesystem, formatting or viewing what is in a
+partition: it is all possible. The <emphasis><guibutton>Clear
+all</guibutton></emphasis> button at the bottom is to erase the complete
+disk, the other buttons become visible on the right after you click on a
+partition.</para>
+
+
+
+ <!-- 2015-07-06 Note added by Lebarhon -->
+<note>
+ <para>If you have an UEFI system, you can see a small partition called "EFI System
+Partition" and mounted on /boot/EFI. Never delete it, because it contains
+all your different operating systems bootloaders.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>If the selected partition is mounted, like in the example below, you cannot
+choose to resize, format or delete it. To be able to do that the partition
+must be unmounted first.</para>
+
+ <para>It is only possible to resize a partition on its right side</para>
+
+ <para>To change a partition type (change ext3 to ext4 for example) you have to
+delete the partition and then re-create it with the new type. The button
+<guibutton role="bold">Create</guibutton> appears when a disk empty part is
+selected</para>
+
+ <para>You can choose a mount point that doesn't exist, it will be created.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakdiskMountedPartition-im1" revision="1" fileref="drakdiskMountedPartition.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Selecting <emphasis><guibutton>Toggle to expert mode</guibutton></emphasis>
+gives some extra available actions, like labeling the partition, as can be
+seen in the screenshot below.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakdiskExpertUnmounted-im1" align="center" fileref="drakdiskExpertUnmounted.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakedm.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakedm.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..14e319ec
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakedm.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakedm">
+ <info>
+
+ <!--2012-09-03 marja: changed title to the title of this screen in MCC .  2017-04-10 simonnzg has looked and seems OK-->
+<title xml:id="drakedm-ti1">Настройка на Графичния мениджър</title>
+ <subtitle>drakedm</subtitle>
+ </info>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="drakedm.png" align="center" xml:id="drakedm-im1" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para xml:id="drakedm-pa1" revision="1">Here<footnote><para xml:id="drakedm-pa3" revision="1">You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakedm</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> you can choose which display
+manager to use to log into your desktop environment. Only the ones available
+on your system will be shown.</para>
+ <para xml:id="drakedm-pa2" revision="1">Most users will only notice that the provided login screens look
+different. However, there are differences in supported features, too. LXDM
+is a lightweight display manager, SDDM and GDM have more extras.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfirewall.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfirewall.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..9c3d9e55
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfirewall.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakfirewall" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakfirewall-ti1">Настройване на лична защитна стена</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakfirewall</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="drakfirewall.png" align="center" xml:id="drakfirewall-im1" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakfirewall</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the Security
+tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled "Set up your personal
+firewall". It is the same tool in the first tab of "Configure system
+security, permissions and audit".</para>
+
+ <para>A basic firewall is installed by default with Mageia. All the incoming
+connections from the outside are blocked if they aren't authorised. In the
+first screen above, you can select the services for which outside connection
+attempts are accepted. For your security, uncheck the first box -
+<guilabel>Everything (no firewall)</guilabel> - unless you want to disable
+the firewall, and only check the needed services.</para>
+
+ <para>It is possible to manually enter the port numbers to open. Click on
+<guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> and a new window is opened. In the field
+<guilabel>Other ports</guilabel>, enter the needed ports following these
+examples :</para>
+
+ <para>80/tcp : open the port 80 tcp protocol</para>
+
+ <para>24000:24010/udp : open all the ports from 24000 to 24010 udp protocol</para>
+
+ <para>The listed ports should be separated by a space.</para>
+
+ <para>If the box <guilabel>Log firewall messages in system logs</guilabel> is
+checked, the firewall messages will be saved in system logs</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakfirewall2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you don't host specific services (web or mail server, file sharing, ...)
+it is completely possible to have nothing checked at all, it is even
+recommended, it won't prevent you from connecting to the internet.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>The next screen deals with the Interactive Firewall options. These feature
+allow you to be warned of connection attempts if at least the first box
+<guilabel>Use Interactive Firewall </guilabel>is checked. Check the second
+box to be warned if the ports are scanned (in order to find a failure
+somewhere and enter your machine). Each box from the third one onwards
+corresponds to a port you opened in the two first screens; in the screenshot
+below, there are two such boxes: SSH server and 80:150/tcp. Check them to be
+warned each time a connection is attempted on those ports.</para>
+
+ <para>These warning are given by alert popups through the network applet.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakfirewall3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakfirewall4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In the last screen, choose which network interfaces are connected to the
+Internet and must be protected. Once the OK button is clicked, the necessary
+packages are downloaded.</para>
+
+ <tip>
+ <para>If you don't know what to choose, have a look in MCC tab Network &amp;
+Internet, icon Set up a new network interface.</para>
+ </tip>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfont.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfont.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..e6929682
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakfont.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,66 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakfont">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakfont-ti1">Управление, добавяне и премахване на шрифтове. Прехвърляне на шрифтове от
+Windows®</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakfont</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakfont-im1" fileref="drakfont.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakfont</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the <emphasis role="bold">System</emphasis> tab. It
+allows you to manage the fonts available on the computer. The main screen
+above shows:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the installed font names, styles and sizes.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>a preview of the selected font.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>some buttons explained here later.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Get Windows Fonts: </emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This button automatically adds the fonts found on the Windows partition. You
+must have Microsoft Windows installed.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Options:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>It allows you to specify the applications or devices (printers mostly) able
+to use the fonts.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Uninstall:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This button is to remove installed fonts and possibly save some place. Be
+careful when removing fonts because it may have serious consequences on the
+documents that use them.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Import:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Allows you to add fonts from a third party (CD, internet, ...). The
+supported formats are ttf, pfa, pfb, pcf, pfm and gsf. Click on the
+<emphasis role="bold">Import</emphasis> button and then on <emphasis
+role="bold">Add</emphasis>, a file manager pops up where you can select the
+fonts to install, click on <emphasis role="bold">Install</emphasis> when
+done. They are installed in the folder /usr/share/fonts.</para>
+
+ <para>If the newly installed (or removed) fonts doesn't appear in the Drakfont
+main screen, close and re open it to see the modifications.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakguard.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakguard.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a94eea04
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakguard.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakguard">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakguard-ti1">Родителски контрол</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakguard</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakguard.png" revision="1" xml:id="drakguard-im1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakguard</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found in the Mageia
+Control Center, under the Security tab, labelled <guilabel>Parental
+Control</guilabel>. If you don't see this label, you have to install the
+drakguard package (not installed by default).</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Presentation</title>
+
+ <para>Drakguard is an easy way to set up parental controls on your computer to
+restrict who can do what, and at which times of day. Drakguard has three
+useful capabilities:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It restricts web access to named users to set times of day. It does this by
+controlling the shorewall firewall built into Mageia.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It blocks execution of particular commands by named users so these users can
+only execute what you accept them to execute.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It restricts access to websites, both manually defined through
+blacklists/whitelists, but also dynamically based on the content of the
+website. To achieve this Drakguard uses the leading opensource parental
+control blocker DansGuardian.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Configuring Parental controls</title>
+
+ <para><warning>
+ <para>If your computer contains hard drive partitions that are formatted in Ext2,
+Ext3, or ReiserFS format you will see a pop up offering to configure ACL on
+your partitions. ACL stands for Access Control Lists, and is a Linux kernel
+feature that allows access to individual files to be restricted to named
+users. ACL is built into Ext4 and Btrfs file systems, but must be enabled by
+an option in Ext2, Ext3, or Reiserfs partitions. If you select 'Yes' to this
+prompt drakguard will configure all your partitions to support ACL, and will
+then suggest you reboot.</para>
+ </warning><guibutton>Enable parental control</guibutton>: If checked, the parental
+control is enabled and the access to <guilabel>Block programs</guilabel> tab
+is opened.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Block all network traffic</guibutton>: If checked, all the
+websites are blocked, except the ones in the whitelist tab. Otherwise, all
+the websites are allowed, except the ones in the blacklist tab.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>User access</guibutton>: Users on the left hand side will have
+their access restricted according to the rules you define. Users on the
+right hand side have unrestricted access so adult users of the computer are
+not inconvenienced. Select a user in the left hand side and click on
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> to add him/her as an allowed user. Select an
+user in the right hand side and click on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to
+remove him/her from the allowed users.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Time control:</guibutton> If checked, internet access is allowed
+with restrictions between the <guilabel>Start</guilabel> time and
+<guilabel>End</guilabel> time. It is totally blocked outside these time
+window.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Blacklist/Whitelist tab</title>
+
+ <para>Enter the website URL in the first field at the top and click on the
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> button.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Block Programs Tab</title>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Block Defined Applications</guibutton>: Enables the use of ACL to
+restrict access to specific applications. Insert the path to the
+applications you wish to block.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Unblock Users list</guibutton>: Users listed on the right hand
+side will not be subject to acl blocking.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakgw.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakgw.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..34ab23f6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakgw.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,123 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakgw" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakgw-ti1">Споделяне на Интернет връзката с други локални компютри</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakgw</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakgw.png" format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="drakgw-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-principles">
+ <title>Principles</title>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../drakgw-net.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>This is useful when you have a
+computer (3) which has Internet (2) access and is connected also to a local
+network (1). You can use computer (3) as a gateway to give that access to
+other workstations (5) and (6) in the local network (1). For this, the
+gateway must have two interfaces; the first one such as an ethernet card
+must be connected to the local network, and the second one (4) connected to
+the Internet (2).</para>
+
+ <para>The first step is to verify that the network and the access to Internet are
+set up, as documented in <xref linkend="draknetcenter"/>.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-wizard">
+ <title>Gateway wizard</title>
+
+ <para>The wizard<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakgw</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> offers successive steps
+which are shown below:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the wizard does not detect at least two interfaces, it warns about this
+and asks to stop the network and configure the hardware.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify the interface used for the Internet connection. The wizard
+automatically suggests one of the interfaces, but you should verify that
+what is proposed is correct.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify which interface is used for the Lan access. The wizard also proposes
+one, check that this is correct.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard proposes parameters for the Lan network, such as IP address, mask
+and domain name. Check that these parameters are compatible with the actual
+configuration. It is recommended that you accept these values.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify if the computer has to be used as a DNS server. If yes, the wizard
+will check that <code>bind</code> is installed. Otherwise, you have to
+specify the address of a DNS server.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify if the computer is to be used as a DHCP server. If yes, the wizard
+will check that <code>dhcp-server</code> is installed and offer to configure
+it, with start and end addresses in the DHCP range.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify if the computer is to be used as a proxy server. If yes, the wizard
+will check that <code>squid</code> is installed and offer to configure it,
+with the address of the administrator (admin@mydomain.com), name of the
+proxy (myfirewall@mydomaincom), the port (3128) and the cache size (100 Mb).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The last step allows you to check if the gateway machine is connected to
+printers and to share them.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+
+ <para>You will be warned about the need to check the firewall if it is active.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-configure">
+ <title>Configure the client</title>
+
+ <para>If you have configured the gateway machine with DHCP, you only need to
+specify in the network configuration tool that you get an address
+automatically (using DHCP). The parameters will be obtained when connecting
+to the network. This method is valid whatever operating system the client is
+using.</para>
+
+ <para>If you must manually specify the network parameters, you must in particular
+specify the gateway by entering the IP-address of the machine acting as the
+gateway.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-stop">
+ <title>Stop connection sharing</title>
+
+ <para>If you want to stop sharing the connection on the Mageia computer, launch
+the tool. It will offer to reconfigure the connection or to stop the
+sharing.</para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakhosts.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakhosts.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8f7ffa8c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakhosts.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakhosts" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakhosts-ti1">Дефиниции на хоста</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakhosts</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" fileref="drakhosts.png" format="PNG" xml:id="drakhosts-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If some systems on your network grant you services, and have fixed
+IP-addresses, this tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakhosts</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows to
+specify a name to access them more easily. Then you can use that name
+instead of the IP-address.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Add</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>With this button, you add the name for a new system. You will get a window
+to specify the IP-address, the host name for the system, and optionally an
+alias which can be used in the same way that the name is.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Modify</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>You can access the parameters of an entry previously defined. You get the
+same window.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakinvictus.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakinvictus.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6c2819dc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakinvictus.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakinvictus" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakinvictus-ti1">Разширени настройки за мрежови устройства и защитна стена</title><subtitle>drakinvictus</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakinvictus-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakinvictus.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakinvictus</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetcenter.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetcenter.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c6f7ea01
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetcenter.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,152 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="draknetcenter">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Written AM desmottes (lebarhon) 2012-08-31
+Write some text means i can't do it :(
+What must we say about networks out of wired (Ethernet) and wireless (WI fi) like GPRS, bluetooth ? I can't write anything.
+-->
+<!-- -->
+<title xml:id="draknetcenter-ti1">Център за управление на мрежови връзки</title>
+ <subtitle>draknetcenter</subtitle>
+ </info>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="draknetcenter.png" align="center" xml:id="draknetcenter-im1" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draknetcenter</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> is found under the Network
+&amp; Internet tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled "Network Center"</para>
+ <para/>
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+ <para>When this tool is launched, a window opens listing all the networks
+configured on the computer, whatever their type (wired, wireless, satellite,
+etc.). When clicking on one of them, three or four buttons appear, depending
+on the network type, to allow you to look after the network, change its
+settings or connect/disconnect. This tool isn't intended to create a
+network, for this see <guilabel>Set up a new network interface (LAN, ISDN,
+ADSL, ...)</guilabel> in the same MCC tab.</para>
+ <para>In the screenshot below, given as example, we can see two networks, the
+first one is wired and connected, recognizable by this icon <inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterEthernet-on.png"/></imageobject></inlinemediaobject> (this one is not connected<inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterEthernet-off.png"/></imageobject></inlinemediaobject> ) and the second section shows wireless
+networks, not connected recognizable by this icon <inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterWireless-off.png"/></imageobject></inlinemediaobject> and this one <inlinemediaobject><imageobject><imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterWireless-on.png"/></imageobject></inlinemediaobject>if connected. For the other network types,
+the colour code is always the same, green if connected and red if not
+connected.</para>
+ <para>In the wireless part of the screen, you can also see all the detected
+networks, with the <guilabel>SSID</guilabel>, the <guilabel>Signal
+strengh</guilabel>, if they are encrypted (in red) or not (in green), and
+the <guilabel>Operating mode</guilabel>. Click on the chosen one and then
+either on <guibutton>Monitor</guibutton>, <guibutton>Configure</guibutton>
+or <guibutton>Connect</guibutton>. It is possible here to go from a network
+to another one. If a private network is selected, the Network Settings
+window (see below) will open and ask you for extra settings ( an encryption
+key in particular).</para>
+ <para>Click on <guibutton>Refresh</guibutton> to update the screen.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>The Monitor button</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>This button allows you to watch the network activity, downloads (toward the
+PC, in red) and uploads (toward the Internet, in green). The same screen is
+available by right clicking on the <guimenu>Internet icon in the system tray
+-> Monitor Network</guimenu>.</para>
+ <para>There is a tab for each network (here eth0 is the wired network, lo the
+local loopback and wlan0 the wireless network) and a tab connection which
+gives details about connection status.</para>
+ <note>
+ <para>At the bottom of the window is a title <guilabel>Traffic
+accounting</guilabel>, we will look at that in the next section.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>The Configure button</title>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">A - For a wired network</emphasis></para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>It is possible to change all the settings given during network
+creation. Most of the time, checking <guibutton>Automatic IP</guibutton>
+<guibutton>(BOOTP/DHCP)</guibutton> will do, but in case of problems, manual
+configuration may give better results.</para>
+ <para>For a residential network, the <guilabel>IP address</guilabel> always looks
+like 192.168.0.x, <guilabel>Netmask</guilabel> is 255.255.255.0, and the
+<guilabel>Gateway</guilabel> and <guilabel>DNS servers</guilabel> are
+available from your providers website.</para>
+ <para><guibutton>Enable traffic accounting</guibutton> if checked this will count
+the traffic on a hourly, daily or monthly basis. The results are visible in
+the Network monitor detailed in the previous section. Once enabled, you may
+have to reconnect to the network.</para>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Allow interface to be controlled by Network
+Manager:</emphasis></para>
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ <para><guibutton>The button Advanced:</guibutton></para>
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">B - For a wireless network</emphasis></para>
+ <para>Only the items not already seen above are explained.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Operating mode:</emphasis></para>
+ <para>Select <guilabel>Managed</guilabel> if the connection is via an access
+point, there is an <emphasis role="bold">ESSID</emphasis> detected. Select
+<guilabel>Ad-hoc</guilabel> if it is a peer to peer network. Select
+<emphasis role="bold">Master</emphasis> if your network card is used as the
+access point, your network card needs to support this mode.</para>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Encryption mode and Encryption key:</emphasis></para>
+ <para>If it is a private network, you need to know these settings.</para>
+ <para><guilabel>WEP</guilabel> uses a password and is weaker than WPA which uses a
+passphrase. <guilabel>WPA Pre-Shared Key</guilabel> is also called WPA
+personal or WPA home. <guilabel>WPA Enterprise</guilabel> is not often used
+in private networks.</para>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Allow access point roaming</emphasis>:</para>
+ <para>Roaming is a technology which enables allows computer to change its access
+point while remaining connected to the network.</para>
+ <para><guibutton>The button Advanced:</guibutton></para>
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>The Advanced Settings button</title>
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetprofile.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetprofile.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..9b2c5664
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknetprofile.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,237 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+
+<section xmlns='http://docbook.org/ns/docbook'
+ xmlns:ns5='http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML'
+ xmlns:ns4='http://www.w3.org/2000/svg'
+ xmlns:ns3='http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml'
+ xmlns:ns2='http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink'
+ xmlns:ns='http://docbook.org/ns/docbook'
+ xml:id='draknetprofile' version='5.0'>
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id='draknetprofile-ti1'>Управление на мрежови профили</title>
+ <subtitle>Draknetprofile</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>Each network interface of a Mageia system is initially configured with a fix
+set of parameters. This corresponds to what is expected by a user of a
+desktop computer, but may not be adequate when the system is moved between
+various network environments: having the system run in different network
+environments will require that multiple configurations co-exist for a given
+network device - otherwise the interface might need to be re-configured each
+time the network environment changes.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Профили</title>
+
+ <para>Linux provides support for multiple configurations of network devices as a
+standard feature. The notion of a <emphasis role='bold'>"network
+profile"</emphasis> refers to a set of configurations of network devices,
+defined for a specific network environment. Each network profile has a
+<emphasis role='bold'>name</emphasis> - the initial configuration that comes
+out of system generation has the name <emphasis>"default"</emphasis>; when a
+new profile is created, a name must be specified which is different from all
+already existing profile names.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Draknetprofile</title>
+
+ <para>Draknetprofile is a - very simple - component of the Mageia Control Center
+(MCC), it provides a Graphical User Interface (GUI) for managing
+profiles. This GUI allows to
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>switch between profiles - i.e. activate a target profile to become the
+"current profile",</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>create a new, additional profile,</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>delete a profile from the list of defined profiles.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Running Draknetprofile</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Defining profiles, profile switching</title>
+
+ <para>Defining/modifying profiles concerns the entire Linux system and all its
+users. Running draknetprofile therefore requires root privileges. Normally,
+launching is achieved from within MCC (which already runs as root):</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id='draknetprofile-im1'
+ fileref='./draknetprofile_mcc.png' format='PNG' align='center'
+ revision='1'/>
+ </imageobject>
+ <caption>
+ <para><emphasis role='bold'>Figure 1: Mageia Control Center: Network &amp;
+Internet tab</emphasis></para>
+ </caption>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>launch the MCC by hitting the MCC icon in one of the panels of your desktop,</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>select the "Network &amp; Internet" tab,</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>hit "Manage different network profiles" in the "Personalize and Secure your
+network" Section (solid red contour in Figure 1).</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>Draknetprofile can also be launched by a command-line instruction from a
+terminal emulator with root privileges (this may be helpful when
+standard-output or error-output from draknetprofile needs to be consulted -
+for instance for debugging). Simply type:</para>
+
+ <informaltable frame='all' colsep='1' rowsep='1'>
+ <tgroup cols='1'>
+ <?dbhtml cellpadding='4' ?>
+ <tbody>
+ <row><?dbhtml bgcolor='#DDDDDD' ?><?dbfo bgcolor='#DDDDDD' ?>
+ <entry><literal>&#x2002;draknetprofile&#x2002;</literal></entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </informaltable>
+
+ <para>After the launch, the main page of Draknetprofile will be displayed:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id='draknetprofile-im2'
+ fileref='./draknetprofile_main.png' format='PNG'
+ align='center' revision='1'/>
+ </imageobject>
+ <caption>
+ <para><emphasis role='bold'>Figure 2: Management actions of
+Draknetprofile</emphasis></para>
+ </caption>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The upper zone of the window contains the list of the names of all presently
+defined profiles. The bottom zone presents a series of buttons:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>"Activate" ... establish the selected profile (top zone of the window) as
+the current profile (and save the properties of the old profile);</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>"New" ... create a new profile;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>"Delete" ... delete the selected profile from the list of defined profiles;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>"Quit" ... exit from Draknetprofile.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>Before hitting the "Activate" or the "Delete" button, you have to select a
+profile from the list: select it by a left-button click on the name of the
+target profile.</para>
+
+ <para>Hitting the "New" button will launch an auxiliary window where you can type
+the name of the profile you want to create; this name must be different from
+any already existing profile. This profile will be created as a precise copy
+of the currently active profile and immediately activated as the current
+profile. You will probably then need to specify its properties (modify the
+automatically created configuration) in a second, independent action:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>exit from Draknetprofile (hit the "Quit" button),</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>back in the "Network &amp; Internet" tab, you select the tab "Set up a new
+network interface (...)" (marked with dashed red contour in Figure 1),</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>you then go through the steps for configuring the interface; they are
+similar to those you did for configuring the original interface during
+system generation - as documented in the <link
+linkend='drakconnect-ti1'>Drakconnect manual</link>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The middle zone of the window is normally hidden, hit the "Advanced" button
+to make it visible. It should display the list of names of Draknetprofile
+<emphasis role='bold'>"modules"</emphasis> (such as "network", "firewall",
+"urpmi"), each with a check-button next to the name; these check-buttons
+determine whether the properties controlled by that module are included into
+the profile or not.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Using a system that has more than one profile</title>
+
+ <para>In a system where several profiles are defined, an additional user
+interaction is required when the system boots: at the very end of the
+bootstrapping activities - just before the Desktop Environment starts - you
+will get a message like</para>
+
+ <informaltable frame='all' colsep='1' rowsep='1'>
+ <tgroup cols='1'>
+ <?dbhtml cellpadding='4' ?>
+ <tbody>
+ <row><?dbhtml bgcolor='#DDDDDD' ?><?dbfo bgcolor='#DDDDDD' ?>
+ <entry><literal>&#x2002;Select network profile: (1) default (2)
+roaming*&#x2002;</literal></entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </informaltable>
+
+ <para>Type 1 or 2 to select the "default", respectively the "roaming" profile, or
+carriage-return to select the profile that is marked with an asterisk (the
+profile that was active when the system had been shut down).</para>
+
+ <para>Presently (Mageia-5) there appears to be an intermittent problem: it happens
+that the system becomes unresponsive after soliciting the user to select a
+profile. The only way out of this situation is to launch another boot. This
+problem is under investigation.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Appendix: Files relevant to Draknetprofile</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration data of network interfaces are stored in the directory
+<emphasis>/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/</emphasis>, in files with names
+like <emphasis>ifcfg-xxx</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>The name of the currently active profile is maintained in the file
+<emphasis>/etc/netprofile/current</emphasis> .
+ </para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknfs.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknfs.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..edf5cde5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draknfs.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,165 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="draknfs" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draknfs-ti1">Споделяне на устройства и директории чрез NFS</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draknfs</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draknfs.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draknfs-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Prerequisites</title>
+
+ <para>When the wizard<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draknfs</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is launched for the
+first time, it may display the following message:</para>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <para>The package nfs-utils needs to be installed. Do you want to install it?</para>
+ </blockquote>
+
+ <para>After completing the installation, a window with an empty list is displayed.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Main window</title>
+
+ <para>A list of directories which are shared is displayed. At this step, the list
+is empty. The <guibutton>Add</guibutton> button gives access to a
+configuration tool.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Промяна на запис</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration tool is labeled "Modify entry". It may be also launched
+with the <guibutton>Modify</guibutton> button. The following parameters are
+available.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draknfs4.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draknfs-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>NFS Directory</title>
+
+ <para>Here you can specify which directory is to be shared. The
+<guibutton>Directory</guibutton> button gives access to a browser to choose
+it.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Достъп до хоста</title>
+
+ <para>Here you can specify the hosts that are authorized to access the shared
+directory.</para>
+
+ <para>NFS clients may be specified in a number of ways:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>single host</emphasis>: a host either by an abbreviated name
+recognized be the resolver, fully qualified domain name, or an IP address</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>netgroups</emphasis>: NIS netgroups may be given as @group.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>wildcards</emphasis>: machine names may contain the wildcard
+characters * and ?. For instance: *.cs.foo.edu matches all hosts in the
+domain cs.foo.edu.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>IP networks</emphasis>: you can also export directories to all
+hosts on an IP (sub-)network simultaneously. For example, either
+`/255.255.252.0' or `/22' appended to the network base address.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>User ID Mapping</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis>map root user as anonymous</emphasis>: maps requests from uid/gid
+0 to the anonymous uid/gid (root_squash). The root user from the client
+cannot read or write to the files on the server which are created by root on
+the server itself.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>allow real remote root access</emphasis>: turn off root
+squashing. This option is mainly useful for diskless clients
+(no_root_squash).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>map all users to anonymous user</emphasis>: maps all uids and gids
+to the anonymous user (all_squash). Useful for NFS-exported public FTP
+directories, news spool directories, etc. The opposite option is no user UID
+mapping (no_all_squash), which is the default setting.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>anonuid and anongid</emphasis>: explicitly set the uid and gid of
+the anonymous account.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Разширени настройки</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Secured Connection</emphasis>: this option requires that requests
+originate on an internet port less than IPPORT_RESERVED (1024). This option
+is on by default.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Read-Only share</emphasis>: allow either only read or both read
+and write requests on this NFS volume. The default is to disallow any
+request which changes the filesystem. This can also be made explicit by
+using this option.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Synchronous access</emphasis>: prevents the NFS server from
+violating the NFS protocol and to reply to requests before any changes made
+by these requests have been committed to stable storage (e.g. disc drive).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Subtree checking</emphasis>: enable subtree checking which can
+help improve security in some cases, but can decrease reliability. See
+exports(5) man page for more details.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Menu entries</title>
+
+ <para>So far the list has at least one entry.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draknfs5.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draknfs-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>File|Write conf</title>
+
+ <para>Save the current configuration.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>NFS Server|Restart</title>
+
+ <para>The server is stopped and restarted with the current configuration files.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>NFS Server|Reload</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration displayed is reloaded from the current configuration
+files.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakproxy.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakproxy.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b85f41c5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakproxy.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakproxy"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakproxy-ti1">Прокси</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakproxy</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakproxy.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakproxy-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If you have to use a proxy server to access to the internet, you can use
+this tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakproxy</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> to configure it. Your net
+administrator will give you the information you need. You can also specify
+some services which can be accessed without the proxy by exception.</para>
+
+ <para>From Wikipedia, on 2012-09-24, article Proxy server: In computer networks, a
+proxy server is a server (a computer system or an application) that acts as
+an intermediary for requests from clients seeking resources from other
+servers. A client connects to the proxy server, requesting some service,
+such as a file, connection, web page, or other resource available from a
+different server. The proxy server evaluates the request as a way to
+simplify and control their complexity.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakrpm-edit-media.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakrpm-edit-media.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6aa6f910
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakrpm-edit-media.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,211 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-ti1">Configure Media</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakrpm-edit-media</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <!-- 2013-01-06 marja - added Qilaq's and spturtle's corrections -->
+<!--2013-10-22 marja - improved wording, thanks to Aragorn :-)
+ - adjusted "Add" part to changed behaviour of this tool
+ (no longer a choice to only add "update sources" is
+ given) -->
+<imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-im1" fileref="drakrpm-edit-media.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><important>
+ <para>First thing to do after an install is to add software sources (also known as
+repositories, media, mirrors). That means you must select the media sources
+to be used to install and update packages and applications. (see Add button
+below).</para>
+ </important> <note>
+ <para>If you install (or upgrade) Mageia using an optical media (DVD or CD) or a
+USB device, there will be a software source configured to the optical media
+used. To avoid being asked to insert the media when you install new
+packages, you should disable (or delete) this media.  (It will have the
+media type CD-Rom).</para>
+ </note> <note>
+ <para>Your system is running under an architecture which may be 32-bit (called
+i586), or 64-bit (called x86_64). Some packages are independent of whether
+your system is 32-bit or 64-bit; these are called noarch packages. They
+don't have their own noarch directories on the mirrors, but are all in both
+the i586 and the x86_64 media.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para>This tool is present in the Mageia Control Center under the tab <emphasis
+role="bold">Software management.</emphasis><footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakrpm-edit-media</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote></para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-columns">The columns</title>
+
+ <bridgehead>Column Enable:</bridgehead>
+
+ <para>The checked media will be used to install new packages. Be cautious with
+some media such as Testing and Debug, they could make your system unusable.</para>
+
+ <bridgehead>Column Update:</bridgehead>
+
+ <para>The checked media will be used to update packages, it must be enabled. Only
+media with "Update" in its name should be selected. For security reasons,
+this column isn't modifiable in this tool, you must open a console as root
+and type <emphasis role="bold">drakrpm-edit-media --expert.</emphasis></para>
+
+ <bridgehead>Column medium:</bridgehead>
+
+ <para>Display the medium name. Mageia official repositories for final release
+versions contain at least:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Core</emphasis> which contains most programs available
+supported by Mageia.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Nonfree</emphasis> which contains some programs which
+are not free</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Tainted</emphasis> free software for which there might
+be patent claims in some countries.</para>
+
+ <para>Each medium has 4 sub-sections:</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Release</emphasis> the packages as of the day the this
+version of Mageia was released.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Updates</emphasis> the packages updated since release
+due to security or bug concerns. Everyone should have this medium enabled,
+even with a very slow internet connection.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Backports</emphasis> some packages of new versions
+backported from Cauldron (the next version under development).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Testing</emphasis> which is used for temporary tests
+of new updates, to allow the bug reporters and the QA team to validate the
+corrections.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-right-button">The buttons on the right</title>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Remove:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>To remove a medium, click on it and then on this button. It is wise to
+remove the medium used for the installation (CD or DVD for example) since
+all the packages it contains are in the official Core release medium.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Edit:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>Allows you to modify the selected medium settings, (URL, downloader and
+proxy).</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Add:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>Add the official repositories available on the Internet. These repositories
+contain only safe and well tested software. Clicking on the "Add" button
+adds the mirrorlist to your configuration, it is designed to make sure that
+you install and update from a mirror close to you. If you prefer to choose a
+specific mirror, then add it by choosing "Add a specific media mirror" from
+the drop-down "File" menu.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Up and down arrows:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>Change the list order. When Drakrpm looks for a package, it reads the list
+in the displayed order and will install the first package found for the same
+release number - in the event of a version mismatch, the latest release will
+be installed. So if possible, put the fastest repositories at the top.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-menu">The menu</title>
+
+ <para><guimenu>File -> Update:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>A window pops up with the media list. Select the ones you want to update and
+click on the <guibutton>Update</guibutton> button.</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>File -> Add a specific media mirror:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>Suppose you aren't happy with the actual mirror, because for example it's
+too slow or often unavailable, you can choose another mirror. Select all the
+actual media and click on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to take them
+out. Click on <guimenu>File -> Add a specific media mirror</guimenu>, choose
+between update only or the full set (if you do not know, choose the
+<guibutton>Full set of sources</guibutton>) and accept the contact by
+clicking on <guibutton>Yes</guibutton>. This window opens:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakrpmEditMedia2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You can see, on the left, a list of countries, choose yours or one very
+close by clicking on the > symbol, this will display all the available
+mirrors in that country. Select one and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>File -> Add a custom medium:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>It is possible to install a new media (from a third party for example) that
+isn't supported by Mageia. A new window appears:</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrakeEditMedia1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>Select the medium type, find a smart
+name that well define the medium and give the URL (or the path, according to
+the medium type)</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>Options -> Global options:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>This item allows you to choose when to "Verify RPMs to be installed" (always
+or never), the download program (curl, wget or aria2) and to define the
+download policy for information about the packages (on demand -by default-,
+update only, always or never).</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>Options -> Manage keys:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>To guarantee a high level of security, digital keys are used to authenticate
+the media. It is possible for each medium to allow or disallow a key. In the
+window that appear, select a medium and then click on
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> to allow a new key or to select a key and click
+on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to disallow that key.</para>
+
+ <para><warning>
+ <para>Do this with care, as with all security-related questions</para>
+ </warning><guimenu>Options -> Proxy:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>If you need to use a proxy server for internet access, you can configure it
+here. You only need to give the <guibutton>Proxy hostname</guibutton> and if
+necessary a <guilabel>Username</guilabel> and <guilabel>Password</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>For more information about configuring the media, see <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Software_management">the Mageia Wiki
+page</link>.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksambashare.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksambashare.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..e33df6f3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksambashare.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,226 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="draksambashare" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksambashare-ti1">Share directories and drives with Samba</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draksambashare</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare.png" format="PNG" align="center" xml:id="draksambashare-im1" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>Samba is a protocol used in different Operating Systems to share some
+resources like directories or printers. This tool allows you to configure
+the machine as a Samba server using the protocol SMB/CIFS. This protocol is
+also used by Windows(R) and workstations with this OS can access the
+resources of the Samba server.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Preparation</title>
+
+ <para>To be accessed from other workstations, the server has to have a fixed IP
+address. This can be specified directly on the server, for example with
+<xref linkend="draknetcenter"/>, or at the DHCP server which identifies the
+station with its MAC-address and give it always the same address. The
+firewall has also to allow the incoming requests to the Samba server.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Wizard - Standalone server</title>
+
+ <para>At the first run, the tools <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing<emphasis
+role="bold"> draksambashare</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> checks if
+needed packages are installed and proposes to install them if they are not
+yet present. Then the wizard to configure the Samba server is launched.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="draksambashare0.png" xml:id="draksambashare0-im1" align="center" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In the next window the Standalone server configuration option is already
+selected.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="draksambashare1.png" align="center" revision="1" xml:id="draksambashare1-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Then specify the name of the workgroup. This name should be the same for the
+access to the shared resources.</para>
+
+ <para>The netbios name is the name which will be used to designate the server on
+the network.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="draksambashare2.png" align="center" revision="1" xml:id="draksambashare2-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose the security mode:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>user</guilabel>: the client must be authorized to access the
+resource</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>share</guilabel>: the client authenticates itself separately for
+each share</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>You can specify which hosts are allowed to access the resources, with IP
+address or host name.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare3.png" format="PNG" align="center" revision="1" xml:id="draksambashare3-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Specify the server banner. The banner is the way this server will be
+described in the Windows workstations.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="draksambashare-im4" align="center" fileref="draksambashare4.png" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The place where Samba can log information can be specified at the next step.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="draksambashare-im5" align="center" fileref="draksambashare5.png" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The wizard displays a list of the chosen parameters before you accept the
+configuration. When accepted, the configuration will be written in
+<code>/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="draksambashare6.png" xml:id="draksambashare-im6" align="center" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Wizard - Primary domain controller</title>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare13.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>If the "Primary domain controller"
+option is selected, the wizard asks for indication if Wins is to support or
+not and to provide admin users names. The following steps are then the same
+as for standalone server, except you can choose also the security mode:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>domain</guilabel>: provides a mechanism for storing all user and
+group accounts in a central, shared, account repository. The centralized
+account repository is shared between (security) controllers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Declare a directory to share</title>
+
+ <para>With the <guibutton>Add</guibutton> button, we get:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" align="center" xml:id="draksambashare-im7" fileref="draksambashare15.png" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>A new entry is thus added. It can be modified with the
+<guibutton>Modify</guibutton> button. Options can be edited, such as whether
+the directory is visible to the public, writable or browseable. The share
+name can not be modified.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" fileref="draksambashare16.png" xml:id="draksambashare-im8" align="center" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Menu entries</title>
+
+ <para>When the list has at least one entry, menu entries can be used.</para>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>File|Write conf</title>
+
+ <para>Save the current configuration in <code>/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>Samba server|Configure</title>
+
+ <para>The wizard can be run again with this command.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>Samba server|Restart</title>
+
+ <para>The server is stopped and restarted with the current configuration files.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>Samba Server|Reload</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration displayed is reloaded from the current configuration
+files.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Printers share</title>
+
+ <para>Samba also allows you to share printers.</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare17.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Samba users</title>
+
+ <para>In this tab, you can add users who are allowed to access the shared
+resources when authentication is required. You can add users from <xref
+linkend="userdrake"/><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare18.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksec.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksec.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1d57a85e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksec.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="draksec">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksec-ti1">Конфигуриране на метод за идентификация за инструментите на Mageia</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draksec</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="draksec-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="draksec0.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draksec</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote>is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Security</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>It allows to give the regular users the needed rights to accomplish tasks
+usually done by the administrator.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on the little arrow before the item you want to drop down:
+ </para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksec.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Most of the tools available in the Mageia Control Center are displayed in
+the left side of the window (see the screenshot above) and for each tool, a
+drop down list on the right side gives the choice between:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Default: The launch mode depends on the chosen security level. See in the
+same MCC tab, the tool "Configure system security, permissions and audit".</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>User password: The user password is asked before the tool launching.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Administrator password: The root password is asked before the tool launching</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>No password: The tool is launched without asking any password.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksnapshot-config.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksnapshot-config.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0bdaec4f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksnapshot-config.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xml:id="draksnapshot-config" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksnapshot-config-ti1">Моментни състояния на системата</title>
+ <subtitle>draksnapshot-config</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="draksnapshot-config-im1" revision="1" align="center"
+ format="PNG" fileref="draksnapshot-config.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draksnapshot-config </emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> is available in MCC's
+<guilabel>System</guilabel> tab, in the <guilabel>Administration
+tools</guilabel> section.</para>
+ <para>When you start this tool in MCC for the first time, you will see a message
+about installing draksnapshot. Click on <guibutton>Install</guibutton> to
+proceed. Draksnapshot and some other packages it needs will be installed.</para>
+
+ <para>Click again on <guilabel>Snapshots</guilabel>, you will see the
+<guilabel>Settings</guilabel> screen. Tick <guilabel>Enable
+Backups</guilabel> and, if you want to backup the whole system,
+<guilabel>Backup the whole system</guilabel>.</para>
+ <para>If you only want to backup part of your directories, then choose
+<guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>. You will see a little pop-up screen. Use the
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> and <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> buttons next to
+the <guilabel>Backup list</guilabel> to include or exclude directories and
+files from the backup. Use the same buttons next to the
+<guilabel>Exclude</guilabel> list to remove subdirectories and/or files from
+the chosen directories, that should <emphasis role="bold">not</emphasis> be
+included in the backup. Click on <guibutton>Close</guibutton> when you are
+done.</para>
+ <para>Now give the path to <guilabel>Where to backup</guilabel>, or choose the
+<guibutton>Browse</guibutton> button to select the correct path. Any mounted
+USB-key or external HD can be found in <emphasis
+role="bold">/run/media/your_user_name/</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+ <para>Click on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton> to make the snapshot.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksound.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksound.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..9bcc14a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/draksound.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,35 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xml:id="draksound" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksound-ti1">Конфигуриране на звука</title>
+ <subtitle>draksound</subtitle>
+ </info>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="draksound-im1" fileref="draksound.png" align="center" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draksound</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Hardware</emphasis>.</para>
+ <para>Draksound deals with the sound configuration, PulseAudio options and
+troubleshooting. It will help you if you experience sound problems or if you
+change the sound card.</para>
+ <para><guilabel>PulseAudio</guilabel> is a sound server. It receives all the sound
+inputs, mixes them according to the user preferences and sends the resulting
+sound to the output. See <guimenu>Menu ->Sound and video -> PulseAudio
+volume control</guimenu> to set these preferences.</para>
+ <para>PulseAudio is the default sound server and it is recommended to leave it
+enabled.</para>
+ <para><guilabel>Glitch-Free</guilabel> improves PulseAudio with some programs. It
+is also recommended to leave it enabled.</para>
+ <para>The <guibutton>Troubleshooting</guibutton> button gives assistance with
+fixing any problems you may have. You will find it helpful to try this
+before asking the community for help.</para>
+ <para>The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button displays a new window with an
+obvious button.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksound1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakups.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakups.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..dd5e1de9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakups.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakups" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakups-ti1">Настройка на UPS за наблюдение на захранването</title><subtitle>drakups</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakups-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakups.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakups</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakvpn.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakvpn.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..dbae4316
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakvpn.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakvpn">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakvpn-ti1">Configure VPN Connection to secure network access</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakvpn</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakvpn-im1" align="center" fileref="drakvpn1.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakvpn</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows to configure secure
+access to a remote network establishing a tunnel between the local
+workstation and the remote network. We discuss here only of the
+configuration on the workstation side. We assume that the remote network is
+already in operation, and that you have the connection information from the
+network administrator, like a .pcf configuration file .</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Конфигурация</title>
+
+ <para>First, select either Cisco VPN Concentrator or OpenVPN, depending on which
+protocol is used for your virtual private network.</para>
+
+ <para>Then give your connection a name.</para>
+
+ <para>At the next screen, provide the details for your VPN connection.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>For Cisco VPN</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakvpn3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>For openvpn. The openvpn package and its dependencies will be installed the
+first time the tool is used.</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakvpn7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>Select the files that you received
+from the network administrator.</para>
+
+ <para>Advanced parameters:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakvpn8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The next screen asks for IP-address of the gateway.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>When the parameters are set, you have the option of starting the VPN
+connection.</para>
+
+ <para>This VPN connection can be set to start automatically with a network
+connection. To do this, reconfigure the network connection to always connect
+to this VPN.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_apache2.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_apache2.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d937c9f1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_apache2.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_apache2" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-ti1">Configure webserver</title><subtitle>drakwizard apache2</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_apache2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard apache2</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can help you to set up a web
+server.
+ </para>
+ <section>
+ <title>What is a web server?</title>
+ <para>
+ Web server is the software that helps to deliver web content that can be
+accessed through the Internet. (From Wikipedia)
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up a web server with drakwizard apache2</title>
+ <para>
+ Welcome to the web server wizard.
+ </para>
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting Server Exposer: Local Net and/or World</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Exposing the web server to the Internet has it's risks. Be ready for bad
+things.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server User Module</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im4" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Allows users to create their own sites.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>User web directory name</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im5" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ The user needs to create and populate this directory, then the server will
+display it.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server Document Root</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im6" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Allows you to configure the path to the web servers default documents.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Обобщение</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im7" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Край</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im8" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_bind.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_bind.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..e4d4b804
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_bind.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_bind" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_bind-ti1">Конфигуриране на DNS</title><subtitle>drakwizard bind</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_bind-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_bind.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard bind</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_dhcp.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_dhcp.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..190b56f6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_dhcp.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,194 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-ti1">Конфигуриране на DHCP</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakwizard dhcp</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im1" fileref="drakwizard_dhcp.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>This tool is broken in Mageia 4 because of new naming scheme for the Net
+interfaces</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard dhcp</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> can help you to set up a
+<acronym>DHCP</acronym> server. It is a component of drakwizard which should
+be installed before you can access to it.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is DHCP?</title>
+
+ <para>The Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (<acronym>DHCP</acronym>) is a
+standardized networking protocol used on IP networks that dynamically
+configures IP addresses and other information that is needed for Internet
+communication. (From Wikipedia)</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up a DHCP server with drakwizard dhcp</title>
+
+ <para>Welcome to the DHCP server wizard.</para>
+
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting Adaptor</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose the network interface, which is connected to the subnet, and for
+which DHCP will assign IP addresses, and then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Select IP range</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step3.png" format="PNG" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Select the beginning and ending IP addresses of the range of IPs you want
+the server to offer, along with the IP of the gateway machine connecting to
+some place outside the local network, hopefully close to the Internet, then
+click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Обобщение</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step4.png" revision="1" align="center" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im5" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Hold on...</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step5.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This can be fixed. Click <guibutton>Previous</guibutton> a few times and
+change things around.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Hours later...</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step6.png" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is done</title>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Installing the package dhcp-server if needed;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Saving <code>/etc/dhcpd.conf</code> in <code>/etc/dhcpd.conf.orig;</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Creating a new <code>dhcpd.conf</code> starting from
+<code>/usr/share/wizards/dhcp_wizard/scripts/dhcpd.conf.default</code> and
+adding the new parameters:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>hname</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>dns</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>net</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>ip</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>mask</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>rng1</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>rng2</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>dname</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>gateway</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>tftpserverip</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>dhcpd_interface</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Also modifying Webmin configuration file
+<code>/etc/webmin/dhcpd/config</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Restarting <code>dhcpd.</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_ntp.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_ntp.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..452f93ea
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_ntp.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,117 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakwizard_ntp"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_ntp-ti1">Конфигуриране на NTP</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakwizard ntp</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <!-- 2013-10-25 Lebarhon - 3 screenshots ready to be added when it is possible -->
+<imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard_ntp.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_ntp-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard ntp</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> purpose is to set the time of
+your server synchronised with an external server. It isn't installed by
+default and you have to also install the drakwizard and drakwizard-base
+packages.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Setup a NTP server with drakwizard ntp</title>
+
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <para>After a welcome screen (see above), the second one ask you to choose three
+time servers in the drop down lists and suggests to use pool.ntp.org twice
+because this server always points to available time servers.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-ntp1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-ntp2.png">
+ <info>
+<author> <personname/> </author> <pubdate/></info>
+ </imagedata>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <para>The following screens allows to choose the region and the city and then, you
+arrive on a summary. If something is wrong, you can obviously change it
+using the <guibutton>Previous</guibutton>button. If everything is right,
+click on the <guibutton>Next</guibutton> button to proceed to the test. It
+may take a while and you finally get this screen below:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-ntp3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <para>Click on the <guibutton>Finish</guibutton> button to close the tool</para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is done</title>
+
+ <para>This tool executes the following steps:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Installing the package <code>ntp</code> if needed</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Saving the files <code>/etc/sysconfig/clock</code> to
+<code>/etc/sysconfig/clock.orig</code> and
+<code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers</code> to
+<code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers.orig</code>;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Writing a new file <code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers</code> with the list of
+servers;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Modifying the file <code>/etc/ntp.conf</code> by inserting the first server
+name;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Stopping and starting <code>crond</code>, <code>atd</code> and
+<code>ntpd</code> services;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Setting the hardware clock to the current system time with UTC reference.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_proftpd.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_proftpd.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2945a6db
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_proftpd.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-ti1">Конфигуриране на FTP</title><subtitle>drakwizard proftpd</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_proftpd.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard proftpd</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can help you to set up an
+<acronym>FTP</acronym> server.
+ </para>
+ <section>
+ <title>What is <acronym>FTP</acronym>?</title>
+ <para>
+ File Transfer Protocol (<acronym>FTP</acronym>) is a standard network
+protocol used to transfer files from one host to another host over a
+<acronym>TCP</acronym>-based network, such as the Internet. (From Wikipedia)
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up an FTP server with drakwizard proftpd</title>
+ <para>
+ Welcome to the FTP wizard. Buckle up.
+ </para>
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting Server Exposer: Local Net and/or World</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Exposing the FTP server to the Internet has it's risks. Be ready for bad
+things.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server Information</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im4" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Enter name the sever will use to introduce itself, someone to email
+complaints too and whether to allow root login access.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im5" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Set listening port, jailed user, allow resumes and/or <acronym>FXP</acronym>
+(File eXchange Protocol)
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Обобщение</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im6" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Край</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im7" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_squid.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_squid.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3ebab9f5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_squid.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,238 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakwizard_squid"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_squid-ti1">Конфигуриране на прокси</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakwizard squid</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard_squid.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard squid</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> can help you to set up a
+proxy server. It is a component of drakwizard which should be installed
+before you can access to it.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is a proxy server?</title>
+
+ <para>A proxy server is a server (a computer system or an application) that acts
+as an intermediary for requests from clients seeking resources from other
+servers. A client connects to the proxy server, requesting some service,
+such as a file, connection, web page, or other resource available from a
+different server and the proxy server evaluates the request as a way to
+simplify and control its complexity. (From Wikipedia)</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up a proxy server with drakwizard squid</title>
+
+ <para>Welcome to the proxy server wizard.</para>
+
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step1.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im2"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting the proxy port</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im3"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Select the proxy port browsers will connect through, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Set Memory and Disk Usage</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step3.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Set memory and disk cache limits, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Select Network Access Control</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step4.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Set visibility to local network or world, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Grant Network Access</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step5.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Grant access to local networks, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Use Upper Level Proxy Server?</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step6.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Cascade through another proxy server? If no, skip next step.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Upper Level Proxy URL and Port</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step7.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im8"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Provide upper level proxy hostname and port, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Обобщение</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step8.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im9"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Start during boot?</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step9.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im10"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose if the proxy server should be started during the boot time, then
+click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Край</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step10.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im11"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is done</title>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Installing the package squid if needed;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Saving <code>/etc/squid/squid.conf</code> in
+<code>/etc/squid/squid.conf.orig;</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Creating a new <code>squid.conf</code> starting from
+<code>squid.conf.default</code> and adding the new parameters:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>cache_dir</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>localnet</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>cache_mem</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>http_port</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>level</code> 1, 2 or 3 and <code>http_access</code> according to level</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>cache_peer</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>visible_hostname</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Restarting <code>squid.</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_sshd.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_sshd.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d8e19ba4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakwizard_sshd.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_sshd" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-ti1">Конфигуриране на OpenSSH</title><subtitle>drakwizard sshd</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_sshd.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard sshd</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can help you to set up an
+<acronym>SSH</acronym> daemon.
+ </para>
+ <section>
+ <title>What is <acronym>SSH</acronym>?</title>
+ <para>
+ Secure Shell (SSH) is a cryptographic network protocol for secure data
+communication, remote command-line login, remote command execution, and
+other secure network services between two networked computers that connects,
+via a secure channel over an insecure network, a server and a client
+(running SSH server and <acronym>SSH</acronym> client programs,
+respectively). (From Wikipedia)
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up an <acronym>SSH</acronym> daemon with drakwizard sshd</title>
+ <para>
+ Welcome to the Open SSH wizard.
+ </para>
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>Select Type of Configure Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Choose <guilabel>Expert</guilabel> for all options or
+<guilabel>Newbie</guilabel> to skip steps 3-7, click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Общи настройки</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Sets visibility and root access options. Port 22 is the standard
+<acronym>SSH</acronym> port.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Authentication Methods</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im4" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Allow a variety of authentication methods users can use while connecting,
+then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Logging</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im5" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Choose logging facility and level of output, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Login Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im6" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Configure per-login settings, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>User Login Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im7" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Configure the user access settings, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Compression and Forwarding</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im8" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Configure X11 forwarding and compression during transfer, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Обобщение</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im9" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Край</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im10" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step9.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakxservices.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakxservices.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..9b38b514
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/drakxservices.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,17 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="drakxservices">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakxservices-ti1">Управление на системни услуги</title>
+ <subtitle>drakxservices</subtitle>
+ </info>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="drakxservices-im1" fileref="drakxservices.png" align="center" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakxservices</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/harddrake2.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/harddrake2.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..483ce3a7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/harddrake2.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,87 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="harddrake2"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="harddrake2-ti1">Hardware configuration</title>
+
+ <subtitle>harddrake2</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="harddrake2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="harddrake2-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">harddrake2</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> gives a general view of the
+hardware of your computer. When the tool is launched, it executes a job to
+look for every element of the hardware. For that, it uses the command
+<code>ldetect </code>which refers to a list of hardware in
+<code>ldetect-lst</code> package.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The window</title>
+
+ <para>The window is divided in two columns.</para>
+
+ <para>The left column contains a list of the detected hardware. The devices are
+grouped by categories. Click on the &gt; to expand the content of a
+category. Each device can be selected in this column.</para>
+
+ <para>The right column displays information about the selected device. The
+<guimenu>Help -&gt; Fields description</guimenu> gives some information
+about the content of the fields.</para>
+
+ <para>According to which type of device is selected, either one or two buttons are
+available at the bottom of the right column:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guibutton>Set current driver options</guibutton>: this can be used to
+parameterize the module which is used in relation to the device. This must
+used by experts only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guibutton>Run config tool</guibutton>: access to the tool which can
+configure the device. The tool can often be accessed directly from the MCC.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The menu</title>
+
+ <para><bridgehead>Опции</bridgehead></para>
+
+ <para>The <guimenu>options</guimenu> menu gives the opportunity to check boxes to
+enable automatic detection:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>modem</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Jaz devices</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Zip parallel devices</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>By default these detections are not enabled, because they are slow. Check
+the appropriate box(es) if you have this hardware connected. Detection will
+be operational the next time this tool is started.</para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/keyboarddrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/keyboarddrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..cd4c30f3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/keyboarddrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="keyboarddrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="keyboarddrake-ti1">Set up the Keyboard Layout</title>
+
+
+
+ <!-- 2012-09-02 marja changed the title to "Set up the Keyboard Layout", so it is the same as the title in MCC -->
+<subtitle>keyboarddrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" fileref="keyboarddrake.png" xml:id="keyboarddrake-im1" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>The keyboarddrake tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">keyboarddrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> helps you
+configure the basic layout for the keyboard that you wish to use on
+Mageia. It affects the keyboard layout for all users on the system. It can
+be found in the Hardware section of the Mageia Control Center (MCC) labelled
+"Configure mouse and keyboard".</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Keyboard Layout</title>
+
+ <para>Here you can select which keyboard layout you wish to use. The names (listed
+in alphabetical order) describe the language, country, and/or ethnicity each
+layout should be used for.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Keyboard Type</title>
+
+ <para>This menu lets you select the type of keyboard you are using. If you are
+unsure of which to choose, it is best to leave it as the default type.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/localedrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/localedrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..34726506
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/localedrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="localedrake"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="localedrake-ti1">Управление на регионални настройки</title>
+
+ <subtitle>localedrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="localedrake.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="localedrake-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can also start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">localedrake</emphasis> as root.
+ </para></footnote> can be found in the System
+section of the Mageia Control Center (MCC) labelled "Manage localization for
+your system". It opens with a window in which you can choose your
+language. The choice is adapted to languages selected during installation.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button give access to activate
+compatibility with old encoding (non UTF8).</para>
+
+ <para>The second window shows a list of countries according to the selected
+language. The button <guibutton>Other Countries</guibutton> gives access to
+countries not listed.</para>
+
+ <para>You have to restart your session after any modifications.</para>
+
+<section xml:id="input_method">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="input_method-ti1">Input method</title>
+ </info>
+ <para>In the <guilabel>Other Countries</guilabel> screen you can also select an
+input method (from the drop-down menu at the bottom of the list). Input
+methods allow users to input multilingual characters (Chinese, Japanese,
+Korean, etc).</para>
+ <para> For Asian and African locales, IBus will be set as default input method so
+users should not need to configure it manually.</para>
+ <para>Other input methods (SCIM, GCIN, HIME, etc.) also provide similar functions
+and can, if not available from the drop-down menu, be installed in another
+part of the Mageia Control Center. See <xref linkend="rpmdrake"></xref>.</para>
+</section>
+
+</section>
+
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/logdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/logdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ddf02cb5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/logdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="logdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="logdrake-ti1">Преглед и търсене в системните дневници</title>
+
+ <subtitle>logdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="logdrake-im1" format="PNG" fileref="logdrake.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">logdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found in the Mageia
+Control Center System tab, labelled "<guilabel>View and search system
+logs</guilabel>".</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>To do a search in the logs</title>
+
+ <para>First, enter the key string you want to look for in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Matching</emphasis> field and/or the key string you want to
+<emphasis>do not</emphasis> wish to see amongst the answers in the field
+<emphasis role="bold">but not matching</emphasis>. Then select the file(s)
+to search in the <guilabel>Choose file</guilabel> field. Optionally, it is
+possible to limit the search to only one day. Select it in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Calendar</emphasis>, using the little arrows on each side of the
+month and year, and check "<guibutton>Show only for the selected
+day</guibutton>". At last, click on the <guibutton>search</guibutton> button
+to see the results in the window called <guilabel>Content of the
+file</guilabel>. It is possible to save the results in the .txt format by
+clicking on the <emphasis role="bold">Save</emphasis> button.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>The <guibutton>Mageia Tools Logs</guibutton> houses the logs from the Mageia
+configuration tools such as the Mageia Control Center tools. These logs are
+updated each time a configuration is modified.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>To configure a mail alert</title>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Mail alert</guibutton> automatically checks the system load and
+the services every hour and if necessary sends an e-mail to the configured
+address.</para>
+
+ <para>To configure this tool, click on the <emphasis role="bold">Mail
+Alert</emphasis> button and then, in the next screen, on the<guibutton>
+Configure the mail alert system</guibutton> drop down button. Here, all the
+running services are displayed and you can choose which ones you want to
+look watch. (See screenshot above).</para>
+
+ <para>The following services can be watched :</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Webmin услуга</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Postfix пощенски сървър</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>FTP сървър</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Apache World Wide Web сървър</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>SSH сървър</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Samba сървър</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Xinetd услуга</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>BIND Domain Name Resolve</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="logdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>In the next screen, select the <guilabel>Load</guilabel> value you consider
+unacceptable. The load represents the demand to a process, a high load slows
+the system down and a very high load may indicate that a process has gone
+out of control. The default value is 3. We recommend setting the load value
+to 3 times the number of processors.</para>
+
+ <para>In the last screen, enter the <guilabel>Email address</guilabel> of the
+person to be warned and the <guilabel>Email server</guilabel> to use (local
+or on the Internet).</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lsnetdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lsnetdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..dab7d366
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lsnetdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section
+xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xml:id="lsnetdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="lsnetdrake-ti1">Display Available NFS And SMB Shares</title>
+ <subtitle>lsnetdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">lsnetdrake</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+ </footnote> can only be started and used
+on the command line.</para>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Documentation
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lspcidrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lspcidrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..377d0aa3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/lspcidrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="lspcidrake">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="lspcidrake-ti1">Display Your PCI, USB and PCMCIA Information</title>
+
+ <subtitle>lspcidrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">lspcidrake</emphasis>.</para>
+ </footnote> can only be started and used
+on the command line. It will give some more information if used under root.</para>
+
+ <para>lspcidrake gives the list of all the connected devices to the computer (USB,
+PCI and PCMCIA) and the used drivers. It needs the ldetect and ldetect-lst
+packages to work.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="lspcidrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>With the -v option, lspcidrake adds the vendor and device identifications.</para>
+
+ <para>lspcidrake often generates very long lists, so, to find an information, it
+is often used in a pipeline with the grep command, like in these examples:</para>
+
+ <para>Information about the graphic card;</para>
+
+ <para><command>lspcidrake | grep VGA</command></para>
+
+ <para>Information about the network</para>
+
+ <para><command>lspcidrake | grep -i network</command></para>
+
+ <para>-i to ignore case distinctions.</para>
+
+ <para>In this screenshot below, you can see the action of the -v option for
+lspcidrake and the -i option for grep.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="lspcidrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>There is another tool that gives information about the hardware, it is
+called <emphasis role="bold">dmidecode</emphasis> (under root)</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-boot.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-boot.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1e95c756
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-boot.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="mcc-boot">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-boot-ti1">Начално зареждане</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-boot.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="mcc-boot-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools to configure your boot
+steps. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране на стъпките за начално зареждане</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakautologin"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakboot"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakedm"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakautologin.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakboot.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakedm.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-hardware.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-hardware.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..7fb1092a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-hardware.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="mcc-hardware">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-hardware-ti1">Хардуер</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-hardware.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-hardware-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools to configure your
+hardware. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Управление на хардуера</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="harddrake2"/><emphasis> = Browse and configure
+hardware</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draksound"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране на графиката</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drak3d"/><emphasis> = Configure 3D Desktop effects</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="XFdrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране на мишка и клавиатура</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="keyboarddrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="mousedrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране на устройства за печат и сканиране</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="system-config-printer"/><emphasis> = Set up the printer(s),
+the print job queues, ...</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="scannerdrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Други</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakups"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="harddrake2.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draksound.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drak3d.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="XFdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="keyboarddrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="mousedrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="system-config-printer.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="scannerdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakups.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-intro.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-intro.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8470fbb2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-intro.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xml:id="mcc-intro"><info><title xml:id="mcc-intro-ti1">About the Manual for the Mageia Control Center</title></info>
+
+
+ <para>The Mageia Control Center (MCC) has eight different options or tabs to
+choose from in the left column, and even ten if the drakwizard package was
+installed. Each of these tabs gives a different set of tools that can be
+selected in the big right panel.</para>
+
+ <para>The ten following chapters are about those ten options and the related
+tools.</para>
+
+<para>The last chapter is about some other Mageia tools, that cannot be chosen in
+any of the MCC tabs.</para>
+
+ <para>The titles of the pages will often be the same as the titles of the tool
+screens.</para>
+
+ <para>There is also a search bar available, which you can access by clicking on
+the "Search" tab in the left column.</para>
+
+ </section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-localdisks.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-localdisks.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ef989365
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-localdisks.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mcc-localdisks" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-localdisks-ti1">Локални дискове</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="mcc-localdisks-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="mcc-localdisks.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools to manage or share your
+local disks. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Локални дискове</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="drakdisk"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--removable"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--fileshare"></xref></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakdisk.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--removable.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--fileshare.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+ </section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-network.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-network.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1fcce443
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-network.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mcc-network" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-network-ti1">Network and Internet</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="mcc-network.png" xml:id="mcc-network-im1" />
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several network tools. Click on a link
+below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Управление на мрежови устройства</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draknetcenter"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakconnect"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakconnect--del"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Персонализация и защита на мрежата</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakproxy"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakgw"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draknetprofile"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakvpn"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Други</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakhosts"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="draknetcenter.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakconnect.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakconnect--del.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakproxy.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakgw.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="draknetprofile.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakvpn.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakhosts.xml"/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networkservices.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networkservices.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d6166068
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networkservices.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,53 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="mcc-networkservices">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-networkservices-ti1">Мрежови услуги</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-networkservices.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-networkservices-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This screen and the one for <emphasis>Sharing</emphasis> are only visible if
+the <emphasis>drakwizard</emphasis> package is installed. You can choose
+between several tools to set up different servers. Click on a link below or
+on <xref linkend="mcc-sharing"/>to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Мрежови услуги</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_dhcp"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_bind"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_squid"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_ntp"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_sshd"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_dhcp.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_bind.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_squid.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_ntp.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_sshd.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networksharing.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networksharing.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..62d5b08f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-networksharing.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mcc-networksharing" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-networksharing-ti1">Мрежово споделяне</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="mcc-networksharing-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="mcc-networksharing.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools for sharing drives and
+directories. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране на Windows(R) споделени ресурси</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--smb"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="draksambashare"></xref><emphasis> = Share drives and
+directories with Windows (SMB) systems</emphasis></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist></listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране NFS споделени ресурси</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--nfs"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="draknfs"></xref></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist></listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist><title>Конфигуриране на WebDAV споделени ресурси</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--dav"></xref></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist></listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--smb.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draksambashare.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--nfs.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draknfs.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--dav.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ </section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-security.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-security.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5b073119
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-security.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="mcc-security">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-security-ti1">Сигурност</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-security.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-security-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several security tools. Click on a
+link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Сигурност</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="msecgui"/><emphasis> = Configure system security, permissions
+and audit</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakfirewall"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draksec"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakinvictus"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakguard"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="msecgui.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakfirewall.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="draksec.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakinvictus.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="drakguard.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-sharing.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-sharing.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2106111c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-sharing.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="mcc-sharing">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-sharing-ti1">Споделяне</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-sharing.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-sharing-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This screen and the one for <emphasis>Network Services</emphasis> are only
+visible if the <emphasis>drakwizard</emphasis> package is installed. You can
+choose between several tools to set up different servers. Click on a link
+below or on <xref linkend="mcc-networkservices"/>to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>Споделяне</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_proftpd"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_apache2"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_proftpd.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_apache2.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-system.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-system.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b0544306
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mcc-system.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,76 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xml:id="mcc-system" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-system-ti1">Система</title>
+ </info>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="mcc-system-im1" fileref="mcc-system.png" align="center" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several system and administration
+tools. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Управление на системни услуги</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para> <xref linkend="drakauth"/> </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakxservices"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakfont"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Локализация</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakclock"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="localedrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>Инструменти за администрация</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="logdrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakconsole"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="userdrake"/><emphasis> = Manage users on system</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="transfugdrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakauth.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakxservices.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakfont.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakclock.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="localedrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="logdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakconsole.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="userdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="transfugdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="draksnapshot-config.xml"/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mgaapplet-config.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mgaapplet-config.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..e23baa33
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mgaapplet-config.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mgaapplet-config" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mgaapplet-config-ti1">Конфигуриране на честотата на обновяванията</title>
+
+ <subtitle>mgaapplet-config</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="mgaapplet-config-im1" format="PNG" fileref="mgaapplet-config.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">mgaapplet-config</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Software
+management</emphasis>. It is also available by a <guimenu>right click /
+Updates configuration</guimenu> on the red icon <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="MageiaUpdate1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject> in the system tray.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>The first slider allows you to change how frequently Mageia will check for
+updates and the second the delay after booting before the first check. The
+check box gives you the option to be warned when a new Mageia release is
+out.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mousedrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mousedrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..642180c3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/mousedrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mousedrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mousedrake-ti1">Настройка на посочващо устройство (мишка, сензорен панел)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>mousedrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="mousedrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="mousedrake.png" align="center" format="PNG" />
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">mousedrake</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Hardware</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>As you must have a mouse to install Mageia, that one is already installed by
+Drakinstall. This tool allows installation of another mouse.</para>
+
+ <para>The mice are sorted by connection type and then by model. Select your mouse
+and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. Most of the time "Universal / Any
+PS/2 &amp; USB mice" is suitable for a recent mouse. The new mouse is
+immediately taken into account.</para>
+
+ </section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/msecgui.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/msecgui.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1a25d7be
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/msecgui.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,358 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="msecgui">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="msecgui-ti1">MSEC: System Security and Audit</title>
+
+ <subtitle>msecgui</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <!-- written by Lebarhon 2014/01/03 To be checked-->
+<imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="msecgui-im1" revision="1" fileref="msecgui.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Presentation</title>
+
+ <para>msecgui<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">msecgui</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is a graphic user interface for
+msec that allows to configure your system security according to two
+approaches:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It sets the system behaviour, msec imposes modifications to the system to
+make it more secure.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It carries on periodic checks automatically on the system in order to warn
+you if something seems dangerous.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>msec uses the concept of "security levels" which are intended to configure a
+set of system permissions, which can be audited for changes or
+enforcement. Several of them are proposed by Mageia, but you can define your
+own customised security levels.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Overview tab</title>
+
+ <para>See the screenshot above</para>
+
+ <para>The first tab takes up the list of the different security tools with a
+button on the right side to configure them:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Firewall, also found in the MCC / Security / Set up your personal firewall</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Updates, also found in MCC / Software Management / Update your system</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>msec itself with some information:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>enabled or not</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the configured Base security level</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the date of the last Periodic checks and a button to see a detailed report
+and another button to execute the checks just now.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Security settings tab</title>
+
+ <para>A click on the second tab or on the Security
+<guibutton>Configure</guibutton> button leads to the same screen shown
+below.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Basic security tab</title>
+
+ <para role="underline">
+ <emphasis role="underline">Security levels:</emphasis>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>After having checked the box <guilabel>Enable MSEC tool</guilabel>, this tab
+allows you by a double click to choose the security level that appears then
+in bold. If the box is not checked, the level « none » is applied. The
+following levels are available:</para>
+
+ <orderedlist numeration="arabic">
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Level <emphasis role="bold">none</emphasis>. This level is intended if you
+do not want to use msec to control system security, and prefer tuning it on
+your own. It disables all security checks and puts no restrictions or
+constraints on system configuration and settings. Please use this level only
+if you are knowing what you are doing, as it would leave your system
+vulnerable to attack.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Level <emphasis role="bold">standard</emphasis>. This is the default
+configuration when installed and is intended for casual users. It
+constrains several system settings and executes daily security checks which
+detect changes in system files, system accounts, and vulnerable directory
+permissions. (This level is similar to levels 2 and 3 from past msec
+versions).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Level <emphasis role="bold">secure</emphasis>. This level is intended when
+you want to ensure your system is secure, yet usable. It further restricts
+system permissions and executes more periodic checks. Moreover, access to
+the system is more restricted. (This level is similar to levels 4 (High) and
+5 (Paranoid) from old msec versions).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Besides those levels, different task-oriented security are also provided,
+such as the <emphasis role="bold">fileserver </emphasis>, <emphasis
+role="bold">webserver</emphasis> and <emphasis
+role="bold">netbook</emphasis> levels. Such levels attempt to pre-configure
+system security according to the most common use cases.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The last two levels called <emphasis role="bold">audit_daily </emphasis> and
+<emphasis role="bold">audit_weekly</emphasis> are not really security levels
+but rather tools for periodic checks only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>These levels are saved in
+<filename>/etc/security/msec/level.&lt;levelname></filename>. You can define
+your own customised security levels, saving them into specific files called
+<filename>level.&lt;levelname></filename>, placed into the folder
+<filename>/etc/security/msec/.</filename> This function is intended for
+power users which require a customised or more secure system configuration.</para>
+
+ <caution>
+ <para>Keep in mind that user-modified parameters take precedence over default
+level settings.</para>
+ </caution>
+
+ <para>
+ <emphasis role="underline">Security alerts:</emphasis>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>If you check the box <guibutton>Send security alerts by email
+to:</guibutton>, the security alerts generated by msec are going to be sent
+by local e-mail to the security administrator named in the nearby field. You
+can fill either a local user or a complete e-mail address (the local e-mail
+and the e-mail manager must be set accordingly). At last, you can receive
+the security alerts directly on your desktop. Check the relevant box to
+enable it.</para>
+
+ <important>
+ <para>It is strongly advisable to enable the security alerts option in order to
+immediately inform the security administrator of possible security
+problems. If not, the administrator will have to regularly check the logs
+files available in <filename>/var/log/security.</filename></para></important>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="underline">Security options:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Creating a customised level is not the only way to customise the computer
+security, it is also possible to use the tabs presented here after to change
+any option you want. Current configuration for msec is stored in
+<filename>/etc/security/msec/security.conf</filename>. This file contains
+the current security level name and the list of all the modifications done
+to the options.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>System security tab</title>
+
+ <para>This tab displays all the security options on the left side column, a
+description in the centre column, and their current values on the right side
+column.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>To modify an option, double click on it and a new window appears (see
+screenshot below). It displays the option name, a short description, the
+actual and default values, and a drop down list where the new value can be
+selected. Click on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> button to validate the
+choice.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui11.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <caution>
+ <para>Do not forget when leaving msecgui to save definitively your configuration
+using the menu <guimenu>File -> Save the configuration</guimenu>. If you
+have changed the settings, msecgui allows you to preview the changes before
+saving them.</para>
+ </caution>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui10.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Network security</title>
+
+ <para>This tab displays all the network options and works like the previous tab</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Periodic checks tab</title>
+
+ <para>Periodic checks aim to inform the security administrator by means of
+security alerts of all situations msec thinks potentially dangerous.</para>
+
+ <para>This tab displays all the periodic checks done by msec and their frequency
+if the box <guibutton>Enable periodic security checks</guibutton> is
+checked. Changes are done like in the previous tabs.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Exceptions tab</title>
+
+ <para>Sometimes alert messages are due to well known and wanted situations. In
+these cases they are useless and wasted time for the administrator. This tab
+allows you to create as many exceptions as you want to avoid unwanted alert
+messages. It is obviously empty at the first msec start. The screenshot
+below shows four exceptions.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>To create an exception, click on the <guibutton>Add a rule</guibutton>
+button</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Select the wanted periodic check in the drop down list called
+<guilabel>Check</guilabel> and then, enter the
+<guilabel>Exception</guilabel> in the text area. Adding an exception is
+obviously not definitive, you can either delete it using the
+<guibutton>Delete</guibutton> button of the <guilabel>Exceptions</guilabel>
+tab or modify it with a double clicK.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Права</title>
+ <para>This tab is intended for file and directory permissions checking and
+enforcement.</para>
+ <para>Like for the security, msec owns different permissions levels (standard,
+secure, ..), they are enabled accordingly with the chosen security
+level. You can create your own customised permissions levels, saving them
+into specific files called <filename>perm.&lt;levelname> </filename> placed
+into the folder <filename>/etc/security/msec/</filename> . This function is
+intended for power users which require a customised configuration. It is
+also possible to use the tab presented here after to change any permission
+you want. Current configuration is stored in
+<filename>/etc/security/msec/perms.conf.</filename> This file contains the
+list of all the modifications done to the permissions.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>Default permissions are visible as a list of rules (a rule per line). You
+can see on the left side, the file or folder concerned by the rule, then the
+owner, then the group and then the permissions given by the rule. If, for a
+given rule:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the box <guilabel>Enforce</guilabel> is not checked, msec only checks if the
+defined permissions for this rule are respected and sends an alert message
+if not, but does not change anything.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the box <guilabel>Enforce</guilabel> is checked, then msec will rule the
+permissions respect at the first periodic check and overwrite the
+permissions.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ <important><para>For this to work, the option CHECK_PERMS in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Periodic check tab</emphasis> must be configured accordingly.</para></important><para>To create a new rule, click on the <guibutton> Add a rule</guibutton> button
+and fill the fields as shown in the example below. The joker * is allowed in
+the <guilabel>File</guilabel> field. “current” means no modification.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui9.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>Click on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> button to validate the choice and do
+not forget when leaving to save definitively your configuration using the
+menu <guimenu>File -> Save the configuration</guimenu>. If you have changed
+the settings, msecgui allows you to preview the changes before saving them. </para>
+ <note><para>It is also possible to create or modify the rules by editing the
+configuration file <filename>/etc/security/msec/perms.conf</filename>.
+ </para></note>
+ <caution><para>Changes in the <emphasis role="bold">Permission tab</emphasis> (or directly
+in the configuration file) are taken into account at the first periodic
+check (see the option CHECK_PERMS in the <emphasis role="bold">Periodic
+checks tab</emphasis>). If you want them to be taken immediately into
+account, use the msecperms command in a console with root rights. You can
+use before, the msecperms -p command to know the permissions that will be
+changed by msecperms.</para></caution>
+ <caution><para>Do not forget that if you modify the permissions in a console or in a file
+manager, for a file where the box <guilabel>Enforce </guilabel> is checked
+in the <emphasis role="bold">Permissions tab </emphasis>, msecgui will write
+the old permissions back after a while, accordingly to the configuration of
+the options CHECK_PERMS and CHECK_PERMS_ENFORCE in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Periodic Checks tab </emphasis>.</para></caution>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/otherMageiaTools.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/otherMageiaTools.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d7781397
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/otherMageiaTools.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="otherMageiaTools">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="otherMageiaTools-ti1">Other Mageia Tools</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>There are more Mageia tools than those that can be started in the Mageia
+Control Center. Click on a link below to learn more, or continue reading the
+next pages.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakbug"/><emphasis>drakbug</emphasis>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakbug_report"/><emphasis>drakbug_report </emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="lsnetdrake"/><emphasis>TO BE WRITTEN </emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="lspcidrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>And more tools?</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakbug.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakbug_report.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="lsnetdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="lspcidrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/rpmdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/rpmdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3f8eef07
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/rpmdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,251 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="rpmdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+ <!--2012-09-03 marja expanded xml:id's of section and title below, because they conflicted with identical xml:id's in another page of MCC help, also replaced first para in some sections with title tags, removed figure tags-->
+<info annotations="simonnzg 6jan2013">
+ <title xml:id="rpmdrake-ti1">Software Management (Install and Remove Software)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>rpmdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="rpmdrake-im1" align="center" fileref="rpmdrake.png" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+
+ <section xml:id="rpmdrake-introduction">
+ <title xml:id="rpmdrake-introduction-ti1">Introduction to rpmdrake</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">rpmdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote>, also known as drakrpm, is a
+program for installing, uninstalling and updating packages. It is the
+graphical user interface of URPMI. At each start up, it will check online
+package lists (called 'media') downloaded straight from Mageia's official
+servers, and will show you each time the latest applications and packages
+available for your computer. A filter system allows you to display only
+certain types of packages: you may display only installed applications (by
+default), or only available updates. You can also view only not installed
+packages. You can also search by the name of a package, or in the summaries
+of descriptions or in the full descriptions of packages or in the file names
+included in the packages.</para>
+
+ <para>To work, rpmdrake needs the repositories to be configured with <xref
+linkend="drakrpm-edit-media"/> .</para>
+
+ <important>
+ <para>During the installation, the configured repository is the medium used for
+the installation, generally the DVD or CD. If you keep this medium, rpmdrake
+will ask it each time you want to install a package, with this pop-up window
+: <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrake8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>If the above message annoys you
+and you have a good internet connection without too strict download limit,
+it is wise to remove that medium and replace it by online repositories
+thanks to <xref linkend="drakrpm-edit-media"/> .</para>
+
+ <para>Moreover, the online repositories are always up to date, contains much more
+packages, and allow to update your installed packages.</para>
+ </important>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The main parts of the screen</title>
+
+ <screenshot>
+<mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></screenshot>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Package type filter:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This filter allows you to display only certain types of packages. The first
+time you start the manager, it only displays applications with a graphical
+interface. You can display either all the packages and all their
+dependencies and libraries or only package groups such as applications only,
+updates only or backported packages from newer versions of Mageia.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>The default filter setting is for new entrants to Linux or Mageia, who
+probably do not want command line or specialist tools. Since you're reading
+this documentation, you're obviously interested in improving your knowledge
+of Mageia, so it is best to set this filter to "All".</para>
+ </warning>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><firstterm> <emphasis role="bold">Package state filter:</emphasis>
+</firstterm></para>
+
+ <para>This filter allows you to view only the installed packages, only the
+packages that are not installed or all of the packages, both installed and
+not installed.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Search mode:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Click on this icon to search through the package names, through their
+summaries, through their complete description or through the files included
+in the packages.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">"Find" box:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Enter here one or more key words. If you want to use more than one keyword
+for searching use '|' between keywords, e.g. To search for "mplayer" and
+"xine" at the same time type 'mplayer | xine'.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Erase all:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This icon can erase in one click all the key words entered in the "Find" box
+.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Categories list:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This side bar groups all applications and packages into clear categories and
+sub categories.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Description panel:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This panel displays the package's name, its summary and complete
+description. It displays many useful elements about the selected package. It
+can also show precise details about the package, the files included in the
+package as well as a list of the last changes made by the maintainer.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The status column</title>
+
+ <para>Once you correctly set the filters, you can find your software either by
+category (in area 6 above) or by name/summary/description using area 4. A
+list of packages fulfilling your query and, don't forget, the chosen medium
+is shown with different status markers according to whether each package is
+installed/not installed/an update... To change this status, just check or
+uncheck the box before the package name and click on
+<guibutton>Apply</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para><table>
+ <title/>
+
+ <tgroup align="left" cols="2">
+ <colspec align="center"/>
+
+ <thead>
+ <row>
+ <entry align="center">Икона</entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle" align="center">Legend</entry>
+ </row>
+ </thead>
+
+ <tbody>
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package is already installed</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package will be installed</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package cannot be modified</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package is an update</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package will be uninstalled</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </table></para>
+
+ <para>Examples in the screenshot above:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If I uncheck digikam (the green arrow tell us it is installed), the status
+icon will go red with an up arrow and it will be uninstalled when clicking
+on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If I check qdigidoc (which is not installed, see the status), the orange
+with a down arrow status icon will appear and it will be installed when
+clicking on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The dependencies</title>
+
+ <screenshot>
+<mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrake7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></screenshot>
+
+ <para>Some packages need other packages called dependencies in order to work. They
+are for example libraries or tools. In this case, Rpmdrake displays an
+information window allowing you to choose whether to accept the selected
+dependencies, cancel the operation or get more information (see above). It
+may also happen that various packages are able to provide the needed
+library, in which case rpmdrake displays the list of alternatives with a
+button to get more information and another button to choose which package to
+install.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/scannerdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/scannerdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2feb8da1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/scannerdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,259 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="scannerdrake"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerdrake-ti1">Настройка на скенер</title>
+ <subtitle>scannerdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <section xml:id="scannerinstallation">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerinstallation-ti1">Installation</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing
+<emphasis>scannerdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to configure a
+single scanner device or a multifunction device which includes scanning. It
+also allows you to share local devices connected to this computer with a
+remote computer or to access remote scanners.</para>
+
+ <para>When you start this tool for the first time, you may get the following
+message:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>"SANE packages need to be installed to use scanners</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Do you want to install the SANE packages?"</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Choose <emphasis>Yes</emphasis> to continue. It will install
+<code>scanner-gui</code> and <code>task-scanning</code> if they are not yet
+installed.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If your scanner is identified correctly, so if in the above screen you see
+the name of your scanner, the scanner is ready for use with, for instance,
+<emphasis>XSane</emphasis> or <emphasis>Simple Scan</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>In that case, you might now want to want to configure the <emphasis>Scanner
+sharing</emphasis> option. You can read about it in the <xref
+linkend="scannersharing"/>.</para>
+
+
+ <para>However, if your scanner hasn't been correctly identified, and checking its
+cable(s) and power switch and then pressing <emphasis>Search for new
+scanners</emphasis> doesn't help, you'll need to press <emphasis>Add a
+scanner manually</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>Choose the brand of your scanner in the list you see, then its type from the
+list for that brand and click <emphasis>Ok</emphasis></para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im2"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you can't find your scanner in the list, then click
+<emphasis>Cancel</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Please check whether your scanner is supported on the <link
+xlink:href="http://www.sane-project.org/lists/sane-mfgs-cvs.html">SANE:
+Supported Devices</link> page and ask for help in the <link
+xlink:href="http://forums.mageia.org/en/">forums</link>.</para>
+ </note>
+
+<figure xml:id="choosescannerport">
+<info>
+ <title xml:id="choosescannerport-ti1">Choose port</title>
+ </info> <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake3.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im3"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></figure>
+
+ <para>You can leave this setting to <emphasis>Auto-detect available
+ports</emphasis> unless your scanner's interface is a parallel port. In that
+case, select <emphasis>/dev/parport0</emphasis> if you have only one.</para>
+
+ <para>After clicking <emphasis>Ok</emphasis>, in most cases you will see a screen
+similar to the one below.</para>
+<para>If you don't get that screen, then please read the <xref
+linkend="scannerextrasteps"/>.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake4.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="scannersharing">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannersharing-ti2">Scannersharing</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake5.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here you can choose whether the scanners connected to this machine should be
+accessible by remote machines and by which remote machines. You can also
+decide here whether scanners on remote machines should be made available on
+this machine.</para>
+
+ <para>Scanner sharing to hosts : name or IP address of hosts can be added or
+deleted from the list of hosts allowed to access the local device(s), on
+this computer.</para>
+
+ <para>Usage of remote scanners : name or IP address of hosts can added or deleted
+from the list of hosts which give access to a remote scanner.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake6.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Scanner sharing to hosts: you can add host.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake7.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Scanner sharing to hosts: specify which host(s) to add, or allow all remote
+machines.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake8.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im8"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>"All remote machines" are allowed to access the local scanner.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake9.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im9"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If the package <emphasis>saned</emphasis> is not yet installed, the tool
+offers to do it.</para>
+
+ <para>At the end, the tool will alter these files:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>/etc/sane.d/saned.conf</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>/etc/sane.d/net.conf</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>/etc/sane.d/dll.conf </emphasis>to add or comment the directive
+"net"</para>
+
+ <para>It will also configure <emphasis>saned</emphasis> and
+<emphasis>xinetd</emphasis> to be started on boot.</para>
+ </section>
+
+<section xml:id="scannerspecifics">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerspecifics-ti2">Specifics</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Hewlett-Packard</para>
+
+ <para>Most HP scanners are managed from <emphasis>HP Device Manager</emphasis>
+(hplip) which also manages printers. In this case, this tool does not allow
+you to configure it and invites you to use <emphasis>HP Device
+Manager</emphasis>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Epson</para>
+
+ <para>Drivers are available from <link
+xlink:href="http://download.ebz.epson.net/dsc/search/01/search/?OSC=LX">this
+page</link>. When indicated, you must install the
+<emphasis>iscan-data</emphasis> package first, then
+<emphasis>iscan</emphasis> (in this order). It is possible that the
+<emphasis>iscan</emphasis> package will generate a warning about a conflict
+with <emphasis>sane</emphasis>. Users have reported that this warning can be
+ignored.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+</section>
+
+<section xml:id="scannerextrasteps">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerextrasteps-ti1">Extra installation steps</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>It is possible that after selecting a port for your scanner in the <xref
+linkend="choosescannerport"/> screen, you need to take one or more extra
+steps to correctly configure your scanner.</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+
+ <listitem>
+<para>In some cases, you're told the scanner needs its firmware to be uploaded
+each time it is started. This tool allows you to load it into the device,
+after you installed it on your system. In this screen you can install the
+firmware from a CD or a Windows installation, or install the one you
+downloaded from an Internet site of the vendor.</para><para>
+ When your device's firmware needs to be loaded, it can take a long time at
+each first usage, possibly more than one minute. So be patient.</para>
+</listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+<para>Also, you may get a screen telling you to adjust the
+<emphasis>/etc/sane.d/"name_of_your_SANE_backend".conf file.</emphasis> </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+<listitem>
+<para>Read those or other instructions you get carefully and if you don't know
+what to do, feel free to ask for help in the <link
+xlink:href="http://forums.mageia.org/en/">forums</link>.</para>
+</listitem>
+
+</itemizedlist>
+
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/software-management.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/software-management.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4c7e5b5d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/software-management.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg"
+xml:id="software-management">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="software-management-ti1">Управление на софтуера</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="software-management-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="software-management.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools for software
+management. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+ <orderedlist><title>Управление на софтуера</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="rpmdrake"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="MageiaUpdate"></xref><emphasis> = Update your
+system</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="mgaapplet-config"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakrpm-edit-media"></xref><emphasis> = Configure media
+sources for install and update</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="rpmdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="MageiaUpdate.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="mgaapplet-config.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="drakrpm-edit-media.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/system-config-printer.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/system-config-printer.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8626d9ff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/system-config-printer.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,341 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="system-config-printer">
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Language proof JohnR 2012/08/28 -->
+<!-- 2012-09-03 marja: made the link to Complete the installation process work (I hope)
+ Lebarhon : added All in one devices in the chapter "Hewlett-Packard printers" 12/13-->
+<title xml:id="system-config-printer-ti1">Install and configure a printer</title>
+
+ <subtitle>system-config-printer</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="system-config-printer-im1" format="PNG" fileref="system-config-printer.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section xml:id="introduction">
+ <title xml:id="introduction-ti1">Въведение</title>
+
+ <para>Printing is managed on Mageia by a server named CUPS. It has its own <link
+ns2:title="CUPS" ns2:href="http://localhost:631">configuration
+interface</link> which is accessible via an Internet browser, but Mageia
+offers its own tool for installing printers called system-config-printer
+which is shared with other distributions such as Fedora, Mandriva, Ubuntu
+and openSUSE.</para>
+
+ <para>You should enable the non-free repository before proceeding with the
+installation, because some drivers may only be available in this way.</para>
+
+ <para>Printer installation is carried out in the <guilabel>Hardware</guilabel>
+section of the Mageia Control Centre. Select the <guilabel>Configure
+printing and scanning</guilabel> tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing
+<emphasis>system-config-printer</emphasis>. The root password will be asked
+for.</para>
+ </footnote>.</para>
+
+ <para>MCC will ask for the installation two packages:</para>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <para>task-printing-server</para>
+
+ <para>task-printing-hp</para>
+ </blockquote>
+
+ <para>It is necessary to accept this installation to continue. Up to 230MB of
+dependencies are needed.</para>
+
+ <para>To add a printer, choose the "Add" printer button. The system will try to
+detect any printers and the ports available. The screenshot displays a
+printer connected to a parallel port. If a printer is detected, such as a
+printer on a USB port, it will be displayed on the first line. The window
+will also attempt to configure a network printer.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="automatic">
+ <title>Automatically detected printer</title>
+
+ <para>This usually refers to USB printers. The utility automatically finds the
+name of the printer and displays it. Select the printer and then click
+"Next". If there is a known driver associated for the printer, it will be
+automatically installed. If there is more than one driver or no known
+drivers, a window will ask you to select or furnish one, as explained in the
+next paragraph. Continue with <xref linkend="terminate"/></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="non_automatic">
+ <title>No automatically detected printer</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="printer3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>When you select a port, the system loads a driver list and displays a window
+to select a driver. The choice can be made through one of the following
+options.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select printer from database</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>provide PPD file</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>search for a driver to download</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>By selecting from the database, the window suggests a printer manufacturer
+first, and then a device and a driver associated with it. If more than one
+driver is suggested, select one which is recommended, unless you have
+encountered some problems with that one before, in this case select the one
+which know to work.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="terminate">
+ <title>Complete the installation process</title>
+
+ <para>After the driver selection, a window requests some information which will
+allow the system to designate and discover the printer. The first line is
+the name under which the device will appear in applications in the list of
+available printers. The installer then suggests printing a test page. After
+this step, the printer is added and appears in the list of available
+printers.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="network_printer">
+ <title>Network printer</title>
+
+ <para>Network printers are printers that are attached directly to a wired or
+wireless network, that are attached to a printserver or that are attached to
+another workstation that serves as printserver.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Often, it is better to configure the DHCP server to always associate a fixed
+IP address with the printer's MAC-address. Of course that should be the same
+as the IP address the printer of printserver is set to, if it has a fixed
+one.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>The printer's Mac-address is a serial number given to the printer or
+printserver or computer it is attached to, that can be obtained from a
+configuration page printed by the printer or which may be written on a label
+on the printer or printserver. If your shared printer is attached to a
+Mageia system, you can run <emphasis><code>ifconfig</code></emphasis> on it
+as root to find the MAC-address. It is the sequence of numbers and letters
+after "HWaddr".</para>
+
+ <para>You can add your network printer by choosing the protocol it uses to talk to
+your computer over the network. If you don't know which protocol to choose,
+you can try the <guilabel>Network Printer</guilabel> - <guilabel>Find
+Network Printer</guilabel> option in the <guilabel>Devices</guilabel> menu
+and give the IP address of the printer in the box on the right, where it
+says "host".</para>
+
+ <para>If the tool recognises your printer or printserver, it will propose a
+protocol and a queue, but you can choose a more appropriate one from the
+list below it or give the correct queue name if it isn't in the list.</para>
+
+ <para>Look in the documentation that came with your printer or printserver to find
+which protocol(s) it supports and for possible specific queue names.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="network_printing_protocols">
+ <title>Network printing protocols</title>
+
+ <para>One current technique is one developed by Hewlett-Packard and known as
+JetDirect. It allows access to a printer directly connected to the network
+via an Ethernet port. You must know the IP-address at which the printer is
+known on the network. This technique is also used inside some ADSL-routers
+which contain an USB port to connect the printer. In this case, the
+IP-address is that of the router. Note that the tool "Hp Device manager" can
+manage dynamically configured IP-adress, setting an URI like
+<emphasis>hp:/net/&lt;name-of-the-printer></emphasis> . In this case, fixed
+IP-adress is not required.</para>
+
+ <para>Choose the option <guilabel>AppSocket/HP JetDirect</guilabel> as the
+protocol and set the address in <guilabel>Host:</guilabel>, do not change
+the <guilabel>Port Number</guilabel>, unless you know that it needs to be
+changed. After the selection of the protocol, the selection of the driver is
+the same as above.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="printer5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The other protocols are:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (ipp)</emphasis>: a printer which can
+be accessed on a TCP/IP network via the IPP protocol, for example a printer
+connected to a station using CUPS. This protocol may also be used also by
+some ADSL-routers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (https): </emphasis>the same as ipp,
+but using http transport and with TLS secured protocol. The port has to be
+defined. By default, the port 631 is used.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (ipps): </emphasis>the same as ipp, but
+with TLS secured protocol.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>LPD/LPR host or Printer</emphasis>: a printer which can be
+accessed on a TCP/IP network via the LPD protocol, for example a printer
+connected to a station using LPD.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Windows printer via SAMBA</emphasis>: a printer connected to a
+station running Windows or a SMB server and shared.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The URI can also be added directly. Here are some examples on how to form
+the URI:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Appsocket</para>
+
+ <para><uri>socket://ip-address-or-hostname:port </uri></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Internet Printing Protocol (IPP)</para>
+
+ <para><uri>ipp://ip-address-or-hostname:port-number/resource</uri></para>
+
+ <para><uri>http://ip-address-or-hostname:port-number/resource</uri></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Line Printer Daemon (LPD) Protocol</para>
+
+ <para><uri>lpd://username@ip-address-or-hostname/queue</uri></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>Additional information can be found in the <link
+ns2:href="http://www.cups.org/documentation.php/doc-1.5/network.html">CUPS
+documentation.</link></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="properties">
+ <title>Device Properties</title>
+
+ <para>You can access the properties of the device. The menu allows access to
+parameters for the CUPS server. By default a CUPS server is launched on your
+system, but you can specify a different one with the
+<guimenu>Server</guimenu> | <guimenuitem>Connect...</guimenuitem> menu,
+another window which gives access to the tuning of other specific parameters
+of the server, following <guimenu>Server</guimenu> |
+<guimenuitem>Settings.</guimenuitem></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="troubleshoot">Troubleshoot</title>
+
+ <para>You can find some information on occurring errors during printing by
+inspecting <filename>/var/log/cups/error_log</filename></para>
+
+ <para>You can also access to a tool to diagnose problems using the
+<guimenu>Help</guimenu> | <guilabel>Troubleshoot</guilabel> menu.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="specificities">
+ <title>Specifics</title>
+
+ <para>It is possible that some drivers for specific printers are not available in
+Mageia or are not functional. In this case, have a look at the <link
+ns2:href="http://openprinting.org/printers/">openprinting</link> site to
+check if a driver for your device is available. If yes, check if the package
+is already present in Mageia and in this case install it manually. Then,
+redo the installation process to configure the printer. In all cases, report
+the problem in bugzilla or on the forum if you are comfortable with this
+tool and furnish the model and driver information and whether the printer
+works or not after installation. Here are some sources to find other
+up-to-date drivers or for more recent devices.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Brother printers</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><link
+ns2:href="http://welcome.solutions.brother.com/bsc/public_s/id/linux/en/download_prn.html">This
+page</link> give a list of drivers provided by Brother. Search the driver
+for your device, download the rpm(s) and install.</para>
+
+ <para>You should install Brother drivers before running the configuration utility.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Hewlett-Packard printers and All in one
+devices</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>These devices use the hplip tool. It is installed automatically after the
+detection or the selection of the printer. You can find other information
+<link
+ns2:href="http://hplipopensource.com/hplip-web/index.html">here</link>. The
+tool "HP Device Manager" is available in the <guilabel>System</guilabel>
+menu. Also view <link
+ns2:href="http://hplipopensource.com/hplip-web/install/manual/hp_setup.html">configuration</link>
+for the management of the printer.</para>
+
+ <para>A HP All in one device must be installed as a printer and the scanner
+features will be added. Note that sometimes, the Xsane interface doesn't
+allow to scan films or slides (the lighting slid can't operate). In this
+case, it is possible to scan, using the standalone mode, and save the
+picture on a memory card or USB stick inserted in the device. Afterwards,
+open your favourite imaging software and load your picture from the memory
+card which is appeared in the /media folder.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Samsung colour printer</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>For specific Samsung and Xerox colour printers, <link
+ns2:href="http://foo2qpdl.rkkda.com/">this site provides drivers</link> for
+the QPDL protocol.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Epson printers and scanners</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Drivers for Epson printers are available from <link
+ns2:href="http://download.ebz.epson.net/dsc/search/01/search/?OSC=LX">this
+search page</link>. For the scanner part, you must install the "iscan-data"
+package first, then "iscan" (in this order). A iscan-plugin package can also
+be available and is to install. Choose the <emphasis>rpm</emphasis> packages
+according to your architecture. </para>
+
+ <para> It is possible that the iscan package will generate a warning about a
+conflict with sane. Users have reported that this warning can be ignored.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Canon printers</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>For Canon printers, it may be advisable to install a tool named turboprint
+<link ns2:href="http://www.turboprint.info/">available here </link>.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/transfugdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/transfugdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..60cf92c0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/transfugdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,138 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="transfugdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Written by yurchor 2013-07-03 -->
+<!-- Tproof -->
+<!-- -->
+<title xml:id="transfugdrake-ti1">Прехвърляне на документи и настройки от Windows(TM)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>transfugdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="transfugdrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="transfugdrake.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">transfugdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the <emphasis
+role="bold">System</emphasis> tab in the Mageia Control Center labeled
+<guilabel>Import Windows(TM) documents and settings</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para>The tool allows an administrator to import the user documents and settings
+from a <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> 2000, <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark> XP or <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark> <trademark>Vista</trademark>
+installation on the same computer as the Mageia installation.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Please note that all the changes will be applied by transfugdrake
+immediately after pressing <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>After starting transfugdrake you will see the first wizard page with some
+explanation about the tool and import options.</para>
+
+ <para>As soon as you read and understand the instructions, press the
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. This should run a detection of
+<trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> installation.</para>
+
+ <para>When the detection step is complete you will see a page which allows you to
+choose accounts in <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> and
+Mageia for the import procedure. It is possible to choose other user account
+than yours own.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Please take into account that due to migrate-assistant (the backend of
+transfugdrake) limitations <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark>
+user account names with special symbols can be displayed incorrectly.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Migration may take some time depending on the size of the document folders.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Some <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> applications
+(especially drivers) may create user accounts for different purposes. For
+example, NVidia drivers in <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark>are updated using
+<emphasis>UpdatusUser</emphasis>. Please do not use such accounts for the
+import purposes.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>When you finished with the accounts selection press
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method
+to import documents:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Transfugdrake is designed to import <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark> data from <emphasis>My
+Documents</emphasis>, <emphasis>My Music</emphasis> and <emphasis>My
+Pictures</emphasis> folders. It is possible to skip import by selecting the
+appropriate item in this window.</para>
+
+ <para>When you finished with the document import method choosing press
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method
+to import bookmarks:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Transfugdrake can import <emphasis>Internet Explorer</emphasis> and
+<emphasis>Mozilla Firefox</emphasis> bookmarks into the bookmarks of Mageia
+<emphasis>Mozilla Firefox</emphasis> instance.</para>
+
+ <para>Choose the preferred import option and press the <guibutton>Next</guibutton>
+button.</para>
+
+
+
+ <!-- Does not work as expected, might be due to incompatible version of OE
+ <para>
+With transfugdrake, it is possible to import <emphasis>Outlook Express</emphasis> settings and mail archives into <emphasis>Evolution</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>When you finished with the mail import method choosing press <guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method to import mail:</para>
+-->
+<para>The next page allows you to import desktop background:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose the preferred option and press the <guibutton>Next</guibutton>
+button.</para>
+
+ <para>The last page of wizard shows some congratulation message. Just press the
+<guibutton>Finish</guibutton> button.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/userdrake.xml b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/userdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0b8fc61a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/docs/stable/mcc-help/bg/userdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,154 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="bg" xml:id="userdrake">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Written AM desmottes (lebarhon) 2012-08-27 -->
+<!-- Tproof -->
+<!-- Preliminary lproof JohnR 2012-08-30 -->
+<!-- -->
+<title xml:id="userdrake-ti1">Потребители и групи</title>
+
+ <subtitle>userdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="userdrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="userdrake.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">userdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the <emphasis
+role="bold">System</emphasis> tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled
+"Manage users on system"</para>
+
+ <para>The tool allows an administrator to manage the users and the groups, this
+means to add or delete a user or group and to modify user and group settings
+(ID, shell, ...)</para>
+
+ <para>When userdrake is opened, all the users existing on the system are listed in
+the <guibutton>Users</guibutton> tab, and all the groups in the
+<guibutton>Groups</guibutton> tab. Both tabs operate the same way.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>1 Add User</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>This button opens a new window with all fields shown empty:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="userdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The field <emphasis role="bold">Full Name</emphasis> is intended for the
+entry of a family name and first name, but it is possible to write anything
+or nothing as well!</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Login</emphasis> is the only required field.</para>
+
+ <para>Setting a <emphasis role="bold">Password</emphasis> is highly
+recommended. There is a little shield on the right, if it is red, the
+password is weak, too short or is too similar to the login name. You should
+use figures, lower and upper case characters, punctuation marks, etc. The
+shield will turn orange and then green as the password strength improves.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Confirm Password</emphasis> field is there to ensure
+you entered what you intended to.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Login Shell </emphasis>is a drop down list that allows
+you to change the shell used by the user you are adding, the options are
+Bash, Dash and Sh.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Create a private group for the user</emphasis>, if
+checked will automatically create a group with the same name and the new
+user as the only member (this may be edited).</para>
+
+ <para>The other options should be obvious. The new user is created immediately
+after you click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">2 Add Group</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>You only need to enter the new group name, and if required, the specific
+group ID.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">3 Edit</emphasis> (a selected user)</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>User Data</guibutton>: Allows you to modify all the data given
+for the user at creation (the ID can't be changed).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Account Info</emphasis>:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="userdrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first option is for setting an expiration date for the account.
+Connection is impossible after this date. This is useful for temporary
+accounts.</para>
+
+ <para>The second option is to lock the account, connection is impossible as long
+as the account is locked.</para>
+
+ <para>It is also possible to change the icon.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Password Info</emphasis>: Allows you to set an
+expiration date for the password, this forces the user to change his
+password periodically.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="userdrake3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Group</emphasis>: Here you can select the groups that
+the user is a member of.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you are modifying a connected user account, modifications will not be
+effective until his/her next login.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">4 Edit</emphasis> (with a group selected)</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Group Data</emphasis>: Allows you to modify the group
+name.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Group Users</emphasis>: Here you can select the users
+who are members of the group</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">5 Delete</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Select a user or a group and click on <emphasis
+role="bold">Delete</emphasis> to remove it. For a user, a window appears to
+ask if home directory and mailbox must also be deleted. If a private group
+has been created for the user, it will be deleted as well.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>It is possible to delete a group which is not empty.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">6 Refresh</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>The User database can be changed outside of Userdrake. Click on this icon to
+refresh the display.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">7 Guest Account</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">guest</emphasis> is a special account. It is intended
+to give somebody temporary access to the system with total security. Login
+is xguest, there is no password, and it is impossible to make modifications
+to the system from this account. The personal directories are deleted at the
+end of the session. This account is enabled by default, to disable it, click
+in the menu on<guimenu> Actions -> Uninstall guest account</guimenu>.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file